]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
(x_scroll_bar_create) [USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS]: Map the
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #if 0
80 #include "sink.h"
81 #include "sinkmask.h"
82 #endif /* ! 0 */
83 #include "gnu.h"
84 #include "disptab.h"
85 #include "buffer.h"
86 #include "window.h"
87 #include "keyboard.h"
88 #include "intervals.h"
89 #include "process.h"
90 #include "atimer.h"
91
92 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
93 #include <X11/Shell.h>
94 #endif
95
96 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
97 #include <sys/time.h>
98 #endif
99 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
100 #include <unistd.h>
101 #endif
102
103 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
104
105 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
106 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
107 int));
108
109 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
110 #define HACK_EDITRES
111 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
112 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
113
114 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
115
116 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
117 #if defined USE_MOTIF
118 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
119 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
120 #include <Xm/ScrollBarP.h>
121 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
122
123 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
124 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
125 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
126 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
127 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
128 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
129 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
130 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
131 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
132 #ifndef XtNpickTop
133 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
134 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
135 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
136 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
137
138 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
139
140 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
141 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
142 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
143 #endif
144
145 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
146 #include "widget.h"
147 #ifndef XtNinitialState
148 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
149 #endif
150 #endif
151
152 #ifndef min
153 #define min(a,b) ((a) < (b) ? (a) : (b))
154 #endif
155 #ifndef max
156 #define max(a,b) ((a) > (b) ? (a) : (b))
157 #endif
158
159 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
160
161 #define BETWEEN(X, LOWER, UPPER) ((X) >= (LOWER) && (X) < (UPPER))
162
163 \f
164 /* Bitmaps for truncated lines. */
165
166 enum bitmap_type
167 {
168 NO_BITMAP,
169 LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP,
170 RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP,
171 OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP,
172 CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP,
173 CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP,
174 ZV_LINE_BITMAP
175 };
176
177 /* Bitmap drawn to indicate lines not displaying text if
178 `indicate-empty-lines' is non-nil. */
179
180 #define zv_width 8
181 #define zv_height 8
182 static unsigned char zv_bits[] = {
183 0x00, 0x00, 0x1e, 0x1e, 0x1e, 0x1e, 0x00, 0x00};
184
185 /* An arrow like this: `<-'. */
186
187 #define left_width 8
188 #define left_height 8
189 static unsigned char left_bits[] = {
190 0x18, 0x0c, 0x06, 0x3f, 0x3f, 0x06, 0x0c, 0x18};
191
192 /* Right truncation arrow bitmap `->'. */
193
194 #define right_width 8
195 #define right_height 8
196 static unsigned char right_bits[] = {
197 0x18, 0x30, 0x60, 0xfc, 0xfc, 0x60, 0x30, 0x18};
198
199 /* Marker for continued lines. */
200
201 #define continued_width 8
202 #define continued_height 8
203 static unsigned char continued_bits[] = {
204 0x3c, 0x7c, 0xc0, 0xe4, 0xfc, 0x7c, 0x3c, 0x7c};
205
206 /* Marker for continuation lines. */
207
208 #define continuation_width 8
209 #define continuation_height 8
210 static unsigned char continuation_bits[] = {
211 0x3c, 0x3e, 0x03, 0x27, 0x3f, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x3e};
212
213 /* Overlay arrow bitmap. */
214
215 #if 0
216 /* A bomb. */
217 #define ov_width 8
218 #define ov_height 8
219 static unsigned char ov_bits[] = {
220 0x30, 0x08, 0x3c, 0x7e, 0x7a, 0x7a, 0x62, 0x3c};
221 #else
222 /* A triangular arrow. */
223 #define ov_width 8
224 #define ov_height 8
225 static unsigned char ov_bits[] = {
226 0x03, 0x0f, 0x1f, 0x3f, 0x3f, 0x1f, 0x0f, 0x03};
227
228 #endif
229
230 extern Lisp_Object Qhelp_echo;
231
232 \f
233 /* Non-zero means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
234
235 int x_toolkit_scroll_bars_p;
236
237 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
238 (The display is done in read_char.) */
239
240 static Lisp_Object help_echo;
241 static Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
242 static Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
243 static int help_echo_pos;
244
245 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
246
247 static Lisp_Object previous_help_echo;
248
249 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
250 start. */
251
252 static int any_help_event_p;
253
254 /* Non-zero means draw block and hollow cursor as wide as the glyph
255 under it. For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be
256 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. */
257
258 int x_stretch_cursor_p;
259
260 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
261 use. */
262
263 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
264
265 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
266 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
267 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
268 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
269
270 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
271
272 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
273 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
274 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
275 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
276
277 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
278
279 extern int waiting_for_input;
280
281 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
282
283 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
284
285 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
286 /* The application context for Xt use. */
287 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
288 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
289 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
290
291 /* Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
292 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
293 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
294
295 struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
296
297 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
298
299 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
300
301 /* Mouse movement.
302
303 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
304 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
305 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
306 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
307
308 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
309
310 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
311 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
312 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
313 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
314 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
315 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
316 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
317 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
318 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
319 is off. */
320
321 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
322
323 FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
324 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
325 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
326
327 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
328
329 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
330 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
331 an ordinary motion.
332
333 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
334 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
335 event. */
336
337 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
338
339 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
340 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
341 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
342 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
343 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
344 it's somewhat accurate. */
345
346 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
347
348 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
349 events. */
350
351 #ifdef __STDC__
352 static int volatile input_signal_count;
353 #else
354 static int input_signal_count;
355 #endif
356
357 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
358
359 static int x_noop_count;
360
361 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
362
363 extern char **initial_argv;
364 extern int initial_argc;
365
366 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
367
368 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
369
370 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
371
372 extern Lisp_Object Qface, Qmouse_face;
373
374 extern int errno;
375
376 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
377
378 extern int extra_keyboard_modifiers;
379
380 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
381
382 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
383 extern Lisp_Object x_icon_type P_ ((struct frame *));
384
385
386 /* Enumeration for overriding/changing the face to use for drawing
387 glyphs in x_draw_glyphs. */
388
389 enum draw_glyphs_face
390 {
391 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
392 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO,
393 DRAW_CURSOR,
394 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE,
395 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED,
396 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
397 };
398
399 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((struct frame *, int *));
400 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
401 static void frame_to_window_pixel_xy P_ ((struct window *, int *, int *));
402 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
403 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
404 unsigned));
405 static int fast_find_position P_ ((struct window *, int, int *, int *,
406 int *, int *));
407 static void set_output_cursor P_ ((struct cursor_pos *));
408 static struct glyph *x_y_to_hpos_vpos P_ ((struct window *, int, int,
409 int *, int *, int *));
410 static void note_mode_line_highlight P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
411 static void note_mouse_highlight P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
412 static void note_tool_bar_highlight P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int));
413 static void x_handle_tool_bar_click P_ ((struct frame *, XButtonEvent *));
414 static void show_mouse_face P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
415 enum draw_glyphs_face));
416 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
417 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
418 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
419 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
420 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
421 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
422 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
423 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
424 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
425 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
426 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
427 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
428 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
429 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
430 static void x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph P_ ((struct window *,
431 struct glyph_row *,
432 enum draw_glyphs_face));
433 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
434 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
435 static void XTreassert_line_highlight P_ ((int, int));
436 static void x_change_line_highlight P_ ((int, int, int, int));
437 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
438 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
439 static void XTcursor_to P_ ((int, int, int, int));
440 static void x_write_glyphs P_ ((struct glyph *, int));
441 static void x_clear_end_of_line P_ ((int));
442 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
443 static void x_clear_cursor P_ ((struct window *));
444 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
445 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
446 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
447 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
448 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
449 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
450 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int));
451 static int x_intersect_rectangles P_ ((XRectangle *, XRectangle *,
452 XRectangle *));
453 static void expose_frame P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int));
454 static void expose_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
455 static void expose_window P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
456 static void expose_area P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
457 XRectangle *, enum glyph_row_area));
458 static void expose_line P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
459 XRectangle *));
460 static void x_update_cursor_in_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, int));
461 static void x_update_window_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int));
462 static void x_erase_phys_cursor P_ ((struct window *));
463 void x_display_and_set_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int, int, int, int, int));
464 static void x_draw_bitmap P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
465 enum bitmap_type));
466
467 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
468 GC, int));
469 static int x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
470 static void x_draw_row_bitmaps P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
471 static void note_overwritten_text_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
472 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
473 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
474 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
475 static void x_draw_vertical_border P_ ((struct window *));
476 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
477 static INLINE void take_vertical_position_into_account P_ ((struct it *));
478 static void x_produce_stretch_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
479
480
481 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
482
483 static void
484 x_flush (f)
485 struct frame *f;
486 {
487 BLOCK_INPUT;
488 if (f == NULL)
489 {
490 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
491 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
492 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
493 }
494 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
495 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
496 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
497 }
498
499
500 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
501 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
502 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
503 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
504 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
505 performance. */
506
507 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
508
509 \f
510 /***********************************************************************
511 Debugging
512 ***********************************************************************/
513
514 #if 0
515
516 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
517 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
518
519 struct record
520 {
521 char *locus;
522 int type;
523 };
524
525 struct record event_record[100];
526
527 int event_record_index;
528
529 record_event (locus, type)
530 char *locus;
531 int type;
532 {
533 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
534 event_record_index = 0;
535
536 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
537 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
538 event_record_index++;
539 }
540
541 #endif /* 0 */
542
543
544 \f
545 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
546
547 struct x_display_info *
548 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
549 Display *dpy;
550 {
551 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
552
553 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
554 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
555 return dpyinfo;
556
557 return 0;
558 }
559
560
561 \f
562 /***********************************************************************
563 Starting and ending an update
564 ***********************************************************************/
565
566 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
567 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
568 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
569 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
570 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
571
572 static void
573 x_update_begin (f)
574 struct frame *f;
575 {
576 /* Nothing to do. */
577 }
578
579
580 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
581 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
582 position of W. */
583
584 static void
585 x_update_window_begin (w)
586 struct window *w;
587 {
588 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
589 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
590
591 updated_window = w;
592 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
593
594 BLOCK_INPUT;
595
596 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
597 {
598 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
599 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
600
601 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
602 highlighting. */
603 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
604 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
605
606 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
607 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
608 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
609 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
610 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
611 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
612
613 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
614 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
615 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
616 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
617 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
618 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
619 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
620 {
621 int i;
622
623 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
624 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
625 break;
626
627 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
628 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
629 }
630 #endif /* 0 */
631 }
632
633 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
634 }
635
636
637 /* Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
638 have vertical scroll bars. */
639
640 static void
641 x_draw_vertical_border (w)
642 struct window *w;
643 {
644 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
645
646 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
647 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
648 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
649 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
650 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
651 && !FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
652 {
653 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
654
655 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
656 x1 += FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
657 y1 -= 1;
658
659 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
660 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x1, y0, x1, y1);
661 }
662 }
663
664
665 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
666
667 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
668 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
669
670 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
671 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
672 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
673
674 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
675 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
676 here. */
677
678 static void
679 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
680 struct window *w;
681 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
682 {
683 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
684 {
685 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
686 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
687
688 BLOCK_INPUT;
689
690 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
691 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
692 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
693 {
694 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
695 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
696 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
697 }
698
699 if (cursor_on_p)
700 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
701 output_cursor.vpos,
702 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
703
704 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
705 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
706 }
707
708 updated_window = NULL;
709 }
710
711
712 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
713 update_end. */
714
715 static void
716 x_update_end (f)
717 struct frame *f;
718 {
719 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
720 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
721
722 BLOCK_INPUT;
723 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
724 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
725 }
726
727
728 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
729 complete update has been performed. The global variable
730 updated_window is not available here. */
731
732 static void
733 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
734 struct frame *f;
735 {
736 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
737 {
738 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
739
740 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
741 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
742 {
743 BLOCK_INPUT;
744 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
745 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
746 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
747 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
748 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
749 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
750 }
751 }
752 }
753
754
755 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
756 arrow bitmaps, or clear the areas where they would be displayed
757 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
758 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
759 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
760 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
761
762 static void
763 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
764 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
765 {
766 struct window *w = updated_window;
767
768 xassert (w);
769
770 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
771 {
772 BLOCK_INPUT;
773 x_draw_row_bitmaps (w, desired_row);
774
775 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
776 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. */
777 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
778 {
779 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
780 int width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
781 int height = desired_row->visible_height;
782 int x = (window_box_right (w, -1)
783 + FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f));
784 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
785
786 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
787 x, y, width, height, False);
788 }
789
790 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
791 }
792 }
793
794
795 /* Draw the bitmap WHICH in one of the areas to the left or right of
796 window W. ROW is the glyph row for which to display the bitmap; it
797 determines the vertical position at which the bitmap has to be
798 drawn. */
799
800 static void
801 x_draw_bitmap (w, row, which)
802 struct window *w;
803 struct glyph_row *row;
804 enum bitmap_type which;
805 {
806 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
807 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
808 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
809 int x, y, wd, h, dy;
810 unsigned char *bits;
811 Pixmap pixmap;
812 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
813 struct face *face;
814 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
815
816 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
817 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 1);
818
819 switch (which)
820 {
821 case LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP:
822 wd = left_width;
823 h = left_height;
824 bits = left_bits;
825 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
826 - wd
827 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
828 break;
829
830 case OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP:
831 wd = left_width;
832 h = left_height;
833 bits = ov_bits;
834 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
835 - wd
836 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
837 break;
838
839 case RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP:
840 wd = right_width;
841 h = right_height;
842 bits = right_bits;
843 x = window_box_right (w, -1);
844 x += (FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2;
845 break;
846
847 case CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP:
848 wd = right_width;
849 h = right_height;
850 bits = continued_bits;
851 x = window_box_right (w, -1);
852 x += (FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2;
853 break;
854
855 case CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP:
856 wd = continuation_width;
857 h = continuation_height;
858 bits = continuation_bits;
859 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
860 - wd
861 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
862 break;
863
864 case ZV_LINE_BITMAP:
865 wd = zv_width;
866 h = zv_height;
867 bits = zv_bits;
868 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
869 - wd
870 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
871 break;
872
873 default:
874 abort ();
875 }
876
877 /* Convert to frame coordinates. Set dy to the offset in the row to
878 start drawing the bitmap. */
879 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
880 dy = (row->height - h) / 2;
881
882 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
883 by the server. */
884 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, BITMAP_AREA_FACE_ID);
885 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, wd, h,
886 face->foreground,
887 face->background, depth);
888 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0, wd, h, x, y + dy);
889 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
890 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
891 }
892
893
894 /* Draw flags bitmaps for glyph row ROW on window W. Call this
895 function with input blocked. */
896
897 static void
898 x_draw_row_bitmaps (w, row)
899 struct window *w;
900 struct glyph_row *row;
901 {
902 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
903 enum bitmap_type bitmap;
904 struct face *face;
905 int header_line_height = -1;
906
907 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
908
909 /* If row is completely invisible, because of vscrolling, we
910 don't have to draw anything. */
911 if (row->visible_height <= 0)
912 return;
913
914 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, BITMAP_AREA_FACE_ID);
915 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
916
917 /* Decide which bitmap to draw at the left side. */
918 if (row->overlay_arrow_p)
919 bitmap = OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP;
920 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p)
921 bitmap = LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP;
922 else if (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row))
923 bitmap = CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP;
924 else if (row->indicate_empty_line_p)
925 bitmap = ZV_LINE_BITMAP;
926 else
927 bitmap = NO_BITMAP;
928
929 /* Clear flags area if no bitmap to draw or if bitmap doesn't fill
930 the flags area. */
931 if (bitmap == NO_BITMAP
932 || FRAME_FLAGS_BITMAP_WIDTH (f) < FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
933 || row->height > FRAME_FLAGS_BITMAP_HEIGHT (f))
934 {
935 /* If W has a vertical border to its left, don't draw over it. */
936 int border = ((XFASTINT (w->left) > 0
937 && !FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
938 ? 1 : 0);
939 int left = window_box_left (w, -1);
940
941 if (header_line_height < 0)
942 header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
943
944 /* In case the same realized face is used for bitmap areas and
945 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
946 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
947 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
948 if (face->stipple)
949 XSetFillStyle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
950 else
951 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, face->background);
952
953 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
954 face->gc,
955 (left
956 - FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
957 + border),
958 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
959 row->y)),
960 FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - border,
961 row->visible_height);
962 if (!face->stipple)
963 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, face->foreground);
964 }
965
966 /* Draw the left bitmap. */
967 if (bitmap != NO_BITMAP)
968 x_draw_bitmap (w, row, bitmap);
969
970 /* Decide which bitmap to draw at the right side. */
971 if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
972 bitmap = RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP;
973 else if (row->continued_p)
974 bitmap = CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP;
975 else
976 bitmap = NO_BITMAP;
977
978 /* Clear flags area if no bitmap to draw of if bitmap doesn't fill
979 the flags area. */
980 if (bitmap == NO_BITMAP
981 || FRAME_FLAGS_BITMAP_WIDTH (f) < FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
982 || row->height > FRAME_FLAGS_BITMAP_HEIGHT (f))
983 {
984 int right = window_box_right (w, -1);
985
986 if (header_line_height < 0)
987 header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
988
989 /* In case the same realized face is used for bitmap areas and
990 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
991 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
992 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
993 if (face->stipple)
994 XSetFillStyle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
995 else
996 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, face->background);
997 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
998 face->gc,
999 right,
1000 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
1001 row->y)),
1002 FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f),
1003 row->visible_height);
1004 if (!face->stipple)
1005 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, face->foreground);
1006 }
1007
1008 /* Draw the right bitmap. */
1009 if (bitmap != NO_BITMAP)
1010 x_draw_bitmap (w, row, bitmap);
1011 }
1012
1013 \f
1014 /***********************************************************************
1015 Line Highlighting
1016 ***********************************************************************/
1017
1018 /* External interface to control of standout mode. Not used for X
1019 frames. Aborts when called. */
1020
1021 static void
1022 XTreassert_line_highlight (new, vpos)
1023 int new, vpos;
1024 {
1025 abort ();
1026 }
1027
1028
1029 /* Call this when about to modify line at position VPOS and change
1030 whether it is highlighted. Not used for X frames. Aborts when
1031 called. */
1032
1033 static void
1034 x_change_line_highlight (new_highlight, vpos, y, first_unused_hpos)
1035 int new_highlight, vpos, y, first_unused_hpos;
1036 {
1037 abort ();
1038 }
1039
1040
1041 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
1042 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
1043 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
1044 rarely happens). */
1045
1046 static void
1047 XTset_terminal_modes ()
1048 {
1049 }
1050
1051 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
1052 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
1056 {
1057 }
1058
1059
1060 \f
1061 /***********************************************************************
1062 Output Cursor
1063 ***********************************************************************/
1064
1065 /* Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
1066 positions are relative to updated_window. */
1067
1068 static void
1069 set_output_cursor (cursor)
1070 struct cursor_pos *cursor;
1071 {
1072 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
1073 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
1074 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
1075 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
1076 }
1077
1078
1079 /* Set a nominal cursor position.
1080
1081 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
1082 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
1083
1084 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
1085 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
1086 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
1087 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
1088
1089 static void
1090 XTcursor_to (vpos, hpos, y, x)
1091 int vpos, hpos, y, x;
1092 {
1093 struct window *w;
1094
1095 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
1096 if (updated_window)
1097 w = updated_window;
1098 else
1099 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
1100
1101 /* Set the output cursor. */
1102 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
1103 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
1104 output_cursor.x = x;
1105 output_cursor.y = y;
1106
1107 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
1108 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
1109 if (updated_window == NULL)
1110 {
1111 BLOCK_INPUT;
1112 x_display_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
1113 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (SELECTED_FRAME ()));
1114 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1115 }
1116 }
1117
1118
1119 \f
1120 /***********************************************************************
1121 Display Iterator
1122 ***********************************************************************/
1123
1124 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
1125
1126 static struct face *x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding P_ ((struct frame *,
1127 struct glyph *,
1128 XChar2b *,
1129 int *));
1130 static struct face *x_get_char_face_and_encoding P_ ((struct frame *, int,
1131 int, XChar2b *, int));
1132 static XCharStruct *x_per_char_metric P_ ((XFontStruct *, XChar2b *));
1133 static void x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *));
1134 static void x_append_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
1135 static void x_append_composite_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
1136 static void x_append_stretch_glyph P_ ((struct it *it, Lisp_Object,
1137 int, int, double));
1138 static void x_produce_glyphs P_ ((struct it *));
1139 static void x_produce_image_glyph P_ ((struct it *it));
1140
1141
1142 /* Return a pointer to per-char metric information in FONT of a
1143 character pointed by B which is a pointer to an XChar2b. */
1144
1145 #define PER_CHAR_METRIC(font, b) \
1146 ((font)->per_char \
1147 ? ((font)->per_char + (b)->byte2 - (font)->min_char_or_byte2 \
1148 + (((font)->min_byte1 || (font)->max_byte1) \
1149 ? (((b)->byte1 - (font)->min_byte1) \
1150 * ((font)->max_char_or_byte2 - (font)->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)) \
1151 : 0)) \
1152 : &((font)->max_bounds))
1153
1154
1155 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
1156 is not contained in the font. */
1157
1158 static INLINE XCharStruct *
1159 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b)
1160 XFontStruct *font;
1161 XChar2b *char2b;
1162 {
1163 /* The result metric information. */
1164 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
1165
1166 xassert (font && char2b);
1167
1168 if (font->per_char != NULL)
1169 {
1170 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
1171 {
1172 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
1173 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
1174 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
1175 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
1176 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
1177 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
1178 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
1179 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1180 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1181 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
1182 }
1183 else
1184 {
1185 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
1186 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
1187 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
1188 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
1189
1190 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
1191 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
1192
1193 where:
1194
1195 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
1196 / = integer division
1197 \ = integer modulus */
1198 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
1199 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
1200 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1201 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1202 {
1203 pcm = (font->per_char
1204 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
1205 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
1206 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
1207 }
1208 }
1209 }
1210 else
1211 {
1212 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
1213 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
1214 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
1215 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1216 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1217 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
1218 }
1219
1220 return ((pcm == NULL
1221 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
1222 ? NULL : pcm);
1223 }
1224
1225
1226 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
1227 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
1228
1229 static INLINE void
1230 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info)
1231 int c;
1232 XChar2b *char2b;
1233 struct font_info *font_info;
1234 {
1235 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
1236 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
1237
1238 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
1239 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
1240 fixed encoding. */
1241 if (font_info->font_encoder)
1242 {
1243 /* It's a program. */
1244 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
1245
1246 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
1247 {
1248 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
1249 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
1250 }
1251 else
1252 {
1253 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
1254 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
1255 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
1256 }
1257
1258 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
1259
1260 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
1261 program. */
1262 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
1263 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
1264 else
1265 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
1266 }
1267 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
1268 {
1269 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
1270 encoding numbers. */
1271 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
1272
1273 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
1274 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
1275 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
1276
1277 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
1278 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
1279 }
1280 }
1281
1282
1283 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame
1284 F. The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1285 means we want to display multibyte text. Value is a pointer to a
1286 realized face that is ready for display. */
1287
1288 static INLINE struct face *
1289 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (f, c, face_id, char2b, multibyte_p)
1290 struct frame *f;
1291 int c, face_id;
1292 XChar2b *char2b;
1293 int multibyte_p;
1294 {
1295 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1296
1297 if (!multibyte_p)
1298 {
1299 /* Unibyte case. We don't have to encode, but we have to make
1300 sure to use a face suitable for unibyte. */
1301 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1302 char2b->byte2 = c;
1303 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, c);
1304 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1305 }
1306 else if (c < 128 && face_id < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
1307 {
1308 /* Case of ASCII in a face known to fit ASCII. */
1309 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1310 char2b->byte2 = c;
1311 }
1312 else
1313 {
1314 int c1, c2, charset;
1315
1316 /* Split characters into bytes. If c2 is -1 afterwards, C is
1317 really a one-byte character so that byte1 is zero. */
1318 SPLIT_CHAR (c, charset, c1, c2);
1319 if (c2 > 0)
1320 char2b->byte1 = c1, char2b->byte2 = c2;
1321 else
1322 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = c1;
1323
1324 /* Maybe encode the character in *CHAR2B. */
1325 if (face->font != NULL)
1326 {
1327 struct font_info *font_info
1328 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
1329 if (font_info)
1330 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info);
1331 }
1332 }
1333
1334 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
1335 xassert (face != NULL);
1336 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1337
1338 return face;
1339 }
1340
1341
1342 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
1343 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
1344 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
1345
1346 static INLINE struct face *
1347 x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, char2b, two_byte_p)
1348 struct frame *f;
1349 struct glyph *glyph;
1350 XChar2b *char2b;
1351 int *two_byte_p;
1352 {
1353 struct face *face;
1354
1355 xassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
1356 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
1357
1358 if (two_byte_p)
1359 *two_byte_p = 0;
1360
1361 if (!glyph->multibyte_p)
1362 {
1363 /* Unibyte case. We don't have to encode, but we have to make
1364 sure to use a face suitable for unibyte. */
1365 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1366 char2b->byte2 = glyph->u.ch;
1367 }
1368 else if (glyph->u.ch < 128
1369 && glyph->face_id < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
1370 {
1371 /* Case of ASCII in a face known to fit ASCII. */
1372 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1373 char2b->byte2 = glyph->u.ch;
1374 }
1375 else
1376 {
1377 int c1, c2, charset;
1378
1379 /* Split characters into bytes. If c2 is -1 afterwards, C is
1380 really a one-byte character so that byte1 is zero. */
1381 SPLIT_CHAR (glyph->u.ch, charset, c1, c2);
1382 if (c2 > 0)
1383 char2b->byte1 = c1, char2b->byte2 = c2;
1384 else
1385 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = c1;
1386
1387 /* Maybe encode the character in *CHAR2B. */
1388 if (charset != CHARSET_ASCII)
1389 {
1390 struct font_info *font_info
1391 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
1392 if (font_info)
1393 {
1394 x_encode_char (glyph->u.ch, char2b, font_info);
1395 if (two_byte_p)
1396 *two_byte_p
1397 = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
1398 }
1399 }
1400 }
1401
1402 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
1403 xassert (face != NULL);
1404 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1405 return face;
1406 }
1407
1408
1409 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
1410 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
1411
1412 static INLINE void
1413 x_append_glyph (it)
1414 struct it *it;
1415 {
1416 struct glyph *glyph;
1417 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1418
1419 xassert (it->glyph_row);
1420 xassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
1421
1422 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1423 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1424 {
1425 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1426 glyph->object = it->object;
1427 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1428 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1429 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
1430 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1431 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1432 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1433 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
1434 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
1435 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1436 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
1437 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1438 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
1439 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1440 }
1441 }
1442
1443 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_id in IT->glyph_row.
1444 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
1445
1446 static INLINE void
1447 x_append_composite_glyph (it)
1448 struct it *it;
1449 {
1450 struct glyph *glyph;
1451 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1452
1453 xassert (it->glyph_row);
1454
1455 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1456 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1457 {
1458 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1459 glyph->object = it->object;
1460 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1461 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1462 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
1463 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1464 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1465 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1466 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
1467 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
1468 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1469 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1470 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1471 glyph->u.cmp_id = it->cmp_id;
1472 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1473 }
1474 }
1475
1476
1477 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
1478 IT->voffset. */
1479
1480 static INLINE void
1481 take_vertical_position_into_account (it)
1482 struct it *it;
1483 {
1484 if (it->voffset)
1485 {
1486 if (it->voffset < 0)
1487 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
1488 in the line. */
1489 it->ascent += abs (it->voffset);
1490 else
1491 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
1492 in the line. */
1493 it->descent += it->voffset;
1494 }
1495 }
1496
1497
1498 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
1499 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
1500 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
1501
1502 static void
1503 x_produce_image_glyph (it)
1504 struct it *it;
1505 {
1506 struct image *img;
1507 struct face *face;
1508
1509 xassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
1510
1511 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1512 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
1513 xassert (img);
1514
1515 /* Make sure X resources of the face and image are loaded. */
1516 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
1517 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
1518
1519 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = image_ascent (img, face);
1520 it->descent = it->phys_descent = img->height + 2 * img->margin - it->ascent;
1521 it->pixel_width = img->width + 2 * img->margin;
1522
1523 it->nglyphs = 1;
1524
1525 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1526 {
1527 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1528 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1529
1530 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1531 it->pixel_width += face->box_line_width;
1532 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1533 it->pixel_width += face->box_line_width;
1534 }
1535
1536 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1537
1538 if (it->glyph_row)
1539 {
1540 struct glyph *glyph;
1541 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1542
1543 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1544 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1545 {
1546 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1547 glyph->object = it->object;
1548 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1549 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1550 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
1551 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1552 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1553 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1554 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
1555 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1556 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1557 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1558 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
1559 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1560 }
1561 }
1562 }
1563
1564
1565 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
1566 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
1567 stretch. ASCENT is the percentage/100 of HEIGHT to use for the
1568 ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= 1). */
1569
1570 static void
1571 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent)
1572 struct it *it;
1573 Lisp_Object object;
1574 int width, height;
1575 double ascent;
1576 {
1577 struct glyph *glyph;
1578 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1579
1580 xassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= 1);
1581
1582 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1583 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1584 {
1585 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1586 glyph->object = object;
1587 glyph->pixel_width = width;
1588 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1589 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
1590 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1591 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1592 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1593 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
1594 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1595 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1596 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1597 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = height * ascent;
1598 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
1599 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1600 }
1601 }
1602
1603
1604 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
1605 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
1606 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
1607 being recognized:
1608
1609 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
1610 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
1611 point number.
1612
1613 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
1614 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
1615 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
1616
1617 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
1618 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
1619
1620 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
1621
1622 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
1623 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
1624
1625 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the the
1626 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
1627 the glyph property.
1628
1629 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
1630
1631 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
1632 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
1633 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
1634
1635 #define NUMVAL(X) \
1636 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
1637 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
1638 : - 1)
1639
1640
1641 static void
1642 x_produce_stretch_glyph (it)
1643 struct it *it;
1644 {
1645 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT. */
1646 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
1647 extern Lisp_Object Qspace;
1648 #endif
1649 extern Lisp_Object QCwidth, QCheight, QCascent;
1650 extern Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
1651 extern Lisp_Object QCalign_to;
1652 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
1653 double width = 0, height = 0, ascent = 0;
1654 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1655 XFontStruct *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
1656
1657 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
1658
1659 /* List should start with `space'. */
1660 xassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
1661 plist = XCDR (it->object);
1662
1663 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
1664 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth),
1665 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1666 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
1667 width = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1668 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width),
1669 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1670 {
1671 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
1672 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
1673 property. */
1674 struct it it2;
1675 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
1676
1677 it2 = *it;
1678 if (it->multibyte_p)
1679 {
1680 int maxlen = ((IT_BYTEPOS (*it) >= GPT ? ZV : GPT)
1681 - IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
1682 it2.c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, maxlen, it2.len);
1683 }
1684 else
1685 it2.c = *p, it2.len = 1;
1686
1687 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
1688 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
1689 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
1690 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
1691 }
1692 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to),
1693 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1694 width = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f) - it->current_x;
1695 else
1696 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
1697 width = CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1698
1699 /* Compute height. */
1700 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight),
1701 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1702 height = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_Y_UNIT (it->f);
1703 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
1704 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1705 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
1706 else
1707 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1708
1709 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
1710 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
1711 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
1712 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
1713 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
1714 ascent = NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
1715 else
1716 ascent = (double) font->ascent / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1717
1718 if (width <= 0)
1719 width = 1;
1720 if (height <= 0)
1721 height = 1;
1722
1723 if (it->glyph_row)
1724 {
1725 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
1726 if (!STRINGP (object))
1727 object = it->w->buffer;
1728 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
1729 }
1730
1731 it->pixel_width = width;
1732 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = height * ascent;
1733 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
1734 it->nglyphs = 1;
1735
1736 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1737 {
1738 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1739 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1740
1741 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1742 it->pixel_width += face->box_line_width;
1743 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1744 it->pixel_width += face->box_line_width;
1745 }
1746
1747 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1748 }
1749
1750 /* Return proper value to be used as baseline offset of font that has
1751 ASCENT and DESCENT to draw characters by the font at the vertical
1752 center of the line of frame F.
1753
1754 Here, out task is to find the value of BOFF in the following figure;
1755
1756 -------------------------+-----------+-
1757 -+-+---------+-+ | |
1758 | | | | | |
1759 | | | | F_ASCENT F_HEIGHT
1760 | | | ASCENT | |
1761 HEIGHT | | | | |
1762 | | |-|-+------+-----------|------- baseline
1763 | | | | BOFF | |
1764 | |---------|-+-+ | |
1765 | | | DESCENT | |
1766 -+-+---------+-+ F_DESCENT |
1767 -------------------------+-----------+-
1768
1769 -BOFF + DESCENT + (F_HEIGHT - HEIGHT) / 2 = F_DESCENT
1770 BOFF = DESCENT + (F_HEIGHT - HEIGHT) / 2 - F_DESCENT
1771 DESCENT = FONT->descent
1772 HEIGHT = FONT_HEIGHT (FONT)
1773 F_DESCENT = (F->output_data.x->font->descent
1774 - F->output_data.x->baseline_offset)
1775 F_HEIGHT = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (F)
1776 */
1777
1778 #define VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET(FONT, F) \
1779 ((FONT)->descent \
1780 + (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT ((F)) - FONT_HEIGHT ((FONT)) \
1781 + (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT ((F)) > FONT_HEIGHT ((FONT)))) / 2 \
1782 - ((F)->output_data.x->font->descent - (F)->output_data.x->baseline_offset))
1783
1784 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
1785 loaded with. See the description of struct display_iterator in
1786 dispextern.h for an overview of struct display_iterator. */
1787
1788 static void
1789 x_produce_glyphs (it)
1790 struct it *it;
1791 {
1792 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1793
1794 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
1795 {
1796 XChar2b char2b;
1797 XFontStruct *font;
1798 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1799 XCharStruct *pcm;
1800 int font_not_found_p;
1801 struct font_info *font_info;
1802 int boff; /* baseline offset */
1803 /* We may change it->multibyte_p upon unibyte<->multibyte
1804 conversion. So, save the current value now and restore it
1805 later.
1806
1807 Note: It seems that we don't have to record multibyte_p in
1808 struct glyph because the character code itself tells if or
1809 not the character is multibyte. Thus, in the future, we must
1810 consider eliminating the field `multibyte_p' in the struct
1811 glyph.
1812 */
1813 int saved_multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1814
1815 /* Maybe translate single-byte characters to multibyte, or the
1816 other way. */
1817 it->char_to_display = it->c;
1818 if (!ASCII_BYTE_P (it->c))
1819 {
1820 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment
1821 && SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
1822 && (it->c >= 0240
1823 || !NILP (Vnonascii_translation_table)))
1824 {
1825 it->char_to_display = unibyte_char_to_multibyte (it->c);
1826 it->multibyte_p = 1;
1827 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
1828 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1829 }
1830 else if (!SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
1831 && !it->multibyte_p)
1832 {
1833 it->char_to_display = multibyte_char_to_unibyte (it->c, Qnil);
1834 it->multibyte_p = 0;
1835 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
1836 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1837 }
1838 }
1839
1840 /* Get font to use. Encode IT->char_to_display. */
1841 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, it->char_to_display,
1842 it->face_id, &char2b,
1843 it->multibyte_p);
1844 font = face->font;
1845
1846 /* When no suitable font found, use the default font. */
1847 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
1848 if (font_not_found_p)
1849 {
1850 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
1851 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
1852 font_info = NULL;
1853 }
1854 else
1855 {
1856 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
1857 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
1858 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
1859 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
1860 }
1861
1862 if (it->char_to_display >= ' '
1863 && (!it->multibyte_p || it->char_to_display < 128))
1864 {
1865 /* Either unibyte or ASCII. */
1866 int stretched_p;
1867
1868 it->nglyphs = 1;
1869
1870 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
1871 it->ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1872 it->descent = font->descent - boff;
1873
1874 if (pcm)
1875 {
1876 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
1877 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
1878 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
1879 }
1880 else
1881 {
1882 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
1883 it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1884 it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1885 it->pixel_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
1886 }
1887
1888 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
1889 `space-width' property, change its width. */
1890 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
1891 if (stretched_p)
1892 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
1893
1894 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
1895 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
1896 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
1897 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1898 {
1899 int thick = face->box_line_width;
1900
1901 it->ascent += thick;
1902 it->descent += thick;
1903
1904 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1905 it->pixel_width += thick;
1906 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1907 it->pixel_width += thick;
1908 }
1909
1910 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
1911 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
1912 if (face->overline_p)
1913 it->ascent += 2;
1914
1915 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1916
1917 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
1918 if (it->glyph_row)
1919 {
1920 if (stretched_p)
1921 {
1922 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
1923 into a stretch glyph. */
1924 double ascent = (double) font->ascent / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1925 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
1926 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
1927 }
1928 else
1929 x_append_glyph (it);
1930
1931 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
1932 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
1933 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
1934 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
1935 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
1936 }
1937 }
1938 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
1939 {
1940 /* A newline has no width but we need the height of the line. */
1941 it->pixel_width = 0;
1942 it->nglyphs = 0;
1943 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1944 it->descent = it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1945
1946 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1947 {
1948 int thick = face->box_line_width;
1949 it->ascent += thick;
1950 it->descent += thick;
1951 }
1952 }
1953 else if (it->char_to_display == '\t')
1954 {
1955 int tab_width = it->tab_width * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1956 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
1957 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
1958
1959 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
1960 stop is less than a canonical character width, use the
1961 tab stop after that. */
1962 if (next_tab_x - x < CANON_X_UNIT (it->f))
1963 next_tab_x += tab_width;
1964
1965 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
1966 it->nglyphs = 1;
1967 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1968 it->descent = it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1969
1970 if (it->glyph_row)
1971 {
1972 double ascent = (double) it->ascent / (it->ascent + it->descent);
1973 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
1974 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
1975 }
1976 }
1977 else
1978 {
1979 /* A multi-byte character. Assume that the display width of the
1980 character is the width of the character multiplied by the
1981 width of the font. */
1982
1983 /* If we found a font, this font should give us the right
1984 metrics. If we didn't find a font, use the frame's
1985 default font and calculate the width of the character
1986 from the charset width; this is what old redisplay code
1987 did. */
1988 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
1989 if (font_not_found_p || !pcm)
1990 {
1991 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (it->char_to_display);
1992
1993 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
1994 it->pixel_width = (FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (it->f))
1995 * CHARSET_WIDTH (charset));
1996 it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1997 it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1998 }
1999 else
2000 {
2001 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
2002 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
2003 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
2004 if (it->glyph_row
2005 && (pcm->lbearing < 0
2006 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
2007 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
2008 }
2009 it->nglyphs = 1;
2010 it->ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2011 it->descent = font->descent - boff;
2012 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2013 {
2014 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2015 it->ascent += thick;
2016 it->descent += thick;
2017
2018 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2019 it->pixel_width += thick;
2020 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2021 it->pixel_width += thick;
2022 }
2023
2024 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2025 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2026 if (face->overline_p)
2027 it->ascent += 2;
2028
2029 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2030
2031 if (it->glyph_row)
2032 x_append_glyph (it);
2033 }
2034 it->multibyte_p = saved_multibyte_p;
2035 }
2036 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
2037 {
2038 /* Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
2039 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs. */
2040 XChar2b char2b;
2041 XFontStruct *font;
2042 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2043 XCharStruct *pcm;
2044 int font_not_found_p;
2045 struct font_info *font_info;
2046 int boff; /* baseline offset */
2047 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_id];
2048
2049 /* Maybe translate single-byte characters to multibyte. */
2050 it->char_to_display = it->c;
2051 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment
2052 && SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
2053 && (it->c >= 0240
2054 || (it->c >= 0200
2055 && !NILP (Vnonascii_translation_table))))
2056 {
2057 it->char_to_display = unibyte_char_to_multibyte (it->c);
2058 }
2059
2060 /* Get face and font to use. Encode IT->char_to_display. */
2061 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
2062 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2063 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, it->char_to_display,
2064 it->face_id, &char2b, it->multibyte_p);
2065 font = face->font;
2066
2067 /* When no suitable font found, use the default font. */
2068 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
2069 if (font_not_found_p)
2070 {
2071 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2072 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
2073 font_info = NULL;
2074 }
2075 else
2076 {
2077 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2078 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2079 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2080 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2081 }
2082
2083 /* There are no padding glyphs, so there is only one glyph to
2084 produce for the composition. Important is that pixel_width,
2085 ascent and descent are the values of what is drawn by
2086 draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of the overall glyphs composed). */
2087 it->nglyphs = 1;
2088
2089 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
2090 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
2091 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
2092 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
2093 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This leads
2094 to incorrect display very rarely, and C-l (recenter) can
2095 correct the display anyway. */
2096 if (cmp->font != (void *) font)
2097 {
2098 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character of
2099 this composition (adjusted by baseline offset). Ascent
2100 and descent of overall glyphs should not be less than
2101 them respectively. */
2102 int font_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2103 int font_descent = font->descent - boff;
2104 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
2105 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
2106 int i, width, ascent, descent;
2107
2108 cmp->font = (void *) font;
2109
2110 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
2111 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
2112 if (pcm)
2113 {
2114 width = pcm->width;
2115 ascent = pcm->ascent;
2116 descent = pcm->descent;
2117 }
2118 else
2119 {
2120 width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2121 ascent = font->ascent;
2122 descent = font->descent;
2123 }
2124
2125 rightmost = width;
2126 lowest = - descent + boff;
2127 highest = ascent + boff;
2128 leftmost = 0;
2129
2130 if (font_info
2131 && font_info->default_ascent
2132 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
2133 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
2134 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
2135 highest = font_info->default_ascent + boff;
2136
2137 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
2138 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn at
2139 the left. */
2140 cmp->offsets[0] = 0;
2141 cmp->offsets[1] = boff;
2142
2143 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
2144 for (i = 1; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
2145 {
2146 int left, right, btm, top;
2147 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
2148 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch);
2149
2150 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
2151 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face->id, &char2b,
2152 it->multibyte_p);
2153 font = face->font;
2154 if (font == NULL)
2155 {
2156 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2157 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
2158 font_info = NULL;
2159 }
2160 else
2161 {
2162 font_info
2163 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2164 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2165 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2166 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2167 }
2168
2169 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
2170 if (pcm)
2171 {
2172 width = pcm->width;
2173 ascent = pcm->ascent;
2174 descent = pcm->descent;
2175 }
2176 else
2177 {
2178 width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2179 ascent = font->ascent;
2180 descent = font->descent;
2181 }
2182
2183 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
2184 {
2185 /* Relative composition with or without
2186 alternate chars. */
2187 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
2188 btm = - descent + boff;
2189 if (font_info && font_info->relative_compose
2190 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
2191 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
2192 make_number (ch)))))
2193 {
2194
2195 if (- descent >= font_info->relative_compose)
2196 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
2197 btm = highest + 1;
2198 else if (ascent <= 0)
2199 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
2200 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
2201 }
2202 }
2203 else
2204 {
2205 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
2206 value that encodes global and new reference
2207 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
2208 specified by numbers as below:
2209
2210 0---1---2 -- ascent
2211 | |
2212 | |
2213 | |
2214 9--10--11 -- center
2215 | |
2216 ---3---4---5--- baseline
2217 | |
2218 6---7---8 -- descent
2219 */
2220 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
2221 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy;
2222
2223 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref);
2224 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
2225 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
2226
2227 left = (leftmost
2228 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
2229 - nrefx * width / 2);
2230 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
2231 : grefy == 1 ? 0
2232 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
2233 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
2234 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
2235 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
2236 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
2237 : (ascent + descent) / 2));
2238 }
2239
2240 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
2241 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
2242
2243 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
2244 right = left + width;
2245 top = btm + descent + ascent;
2246 if (left < leftmost)
2247 leftmost = left;
2248 if (right > rightmost)
2249 rightmost = right;
2250 if (top > highest)
2251 highest = top;
2252 if (btm < lowest)
2253 lowest = btm;
2254 }
2255
2256 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
2257 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
2258 non-negative. */
2259 if (leftmost < 0)
2260 {
2261 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
2262 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
2263 rightmost -= leftmost;
2264 }
2265
2266 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
2267 cmp->ascent = highest;
2268 cmp->descent = - lowest;
2269 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
2270 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
2271 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
2272 cmp->descent = font_descent;
2273 }
2274
2275 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
2276 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
2277 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
2278
2279 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2280 {
2281 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2282 it->ascent += thick;
2283 it->descent += thick;
2284
2285 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2286 it->pixel_width += thick;
2287 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2288 it->pixel_width += thick;
2289 }
2290
2291 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2292 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2293 if (face->overline_p)
2294 it->ascent += 2;
2295
2296 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2297
2298 if (it->glyph_row)
2299 x_append_composite_glyph (it);
2300 }
2301 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
2302 x_produce_image_glyph (it);
2303 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
2304 x_produce_stretch_glyph (it);
2305
2306 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
2307 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
2308 xassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
2309 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
2310 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
2311
2312 it->descent += it->extra_line_spacing;
2313
2314 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
2315 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
2316 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
2317 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
2318 }
2319
2320
2321 /* Estimate the pixel height of the mode or top line on frame F.
2322 FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
2323
2324 int
2325 x_estimate_mode_line_height (f, face_id)
2326 struct frame *f;
2327 enum face_id face_id;
2328 {
2329 int height = 1;
2330
2331 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
2332 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
2333 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
2334 {
2335 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
2336 if (face)
2337 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font) + 2 * face->box_line_width;
2338 }
2339
2340 return height;
2341 }
2342
2343 \f
2344 /***********************************************************************
2345 Glyph display
2346 ***********************************************************************/
2347
2348 /* A sequence of glyphs to be drawn in the same face.
2349
2350 This data structure is not really completely X specific, so it
2351 could possibly, at least partially, be useful for other systems. It
2352 is currently not part of the external redisplay interface because
2353 it's not clear what other systems will need. */
2354
2355 struct glyph_string
2356 {
2357 /* X-origin of the string. */
2358 int x;
2359
2360 /* Y-origin and y-position of the base line of this string. */
2361 int y, ybase;
2362
2363 /* The width of the string, not including a face extension. */
2364 int width;
2365
2366 /* The width of the string, including a face extension. */
2367 int background_width;
2368
2369 /* The height of this string. This is the height of the line this
2370 string is drawn in, and can be different from the height of the
2371 font the string is drawn in. */
2372 int height;
2373
2374 /* Number of pixels this string overwrites in front of its x-origin.
2375 This number is zero if the string has an lbearing >= 0; it is
2376 -lbearing, if the string has an lbearing < 0. */
2377 int left_overhang;
2378
2379 /* Number of pixels this string overwrites past its right-most
2380 nominal x-position, i.e. x + width. Zero if the string's
2381 rbearing is <= its nominal width, rbearing - width otherwise. */
2382 int right_overhang;
2383
2384 /* The frame on which the glyph string is drawn. */
2385 struct frame *f;
2386
2387 /* The window on which the glyph string is drawn. */
2388 struct window *w;
2389
2390 /* X display and window for convenience. */
2391 Display *display;
2392 Window window;
2393
2394 /* The glyph row for which this string was built. It determines the
2395 y-origin and height of the string. */
2396 struct glyph_row *row;
2397
2398 /* The area within row. */
2399 enum glyph_row_area area;
2400
2401 /* Characters to be drawn, and number of characters. */
2402 XChar2b *char2b;
2403 int nchars;
2404
2405 /* A face-override for drawing cursors, mouse face and similar. */
2406 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
2407
2408 /* Face in which this string is to be drawn. */
2409 struct face *face;
2410
2411 /* Font in which this string is to be drawn. */
2412 XFontStruct *font;
2413
2414 /* Font info for this string. */
2415 struct font_info *font_info;
2416
2417 /* Non-null means this string describes (part of) a composition.
2418 All characters from char2b are drawn composed. */
2419 struct composition *cmp;
2420
2421 /* Index of this glyph string's first character in the glyph
2422 definition of CMP. If this is zero, this glyph string describes
2423 the first character of a composition. */
2424 int gidx;
2425
2426 /* 1 means this glyph strings face has to be drawn to the right end
2427 of the window's drawing area. */
2428 unsigned extends_to_end_of_line_p : 1;
2429
2430 /* 1 means the background of this string has been drawn. */
2431 unsigned background_filled_p : 1;
2432
2433 /* 1 means glyph string must be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
2434 unsigned two_byte_p : 1;
2435
2436 /* 1 means that the original font determined for drawing this glyph
2437 string could not be loaded. The member `font' has been set to
2438 the frame's default font in this case. */
2439 unsigned font_not_found_p : 1;
2440
2441 /* 1 means that the face in which this glyph string is drawn has a
2442 stipple pattern. */
2443 unsigned stippled_p : 1;
2444
2445 /* 1 means only the foreground of this glyph string must be drawn,
2446 and we should use the physical height of the line this glyph
2447 string appears in as clip rect. */
2448 unsigned for_overlaps_p : 1;
2449
2450 /* The GC to use for drawing this glyph string. */
2451 GC gc;
2452
2453 /* A pointer to the first glyph in the string. This glyph
2454 corresponds to char2b[0]. Needed to draw rectangles if
2455 font_not_found_p is 1. */
2456 struct glyph *first_glyph;
2457
2458 /* Image, if any. */
2459 struct image *img;
2460
2461 struct glyph_string *next, *prev;
2462 };
2463
2464
2465 #if 0
2466
2467 static void
2468 x_dump_glyph_string (s)
2469 struct glyph_string *s;
2470 {
2471 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
2472 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
2473 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
2474 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
2475 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
2476 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
2477 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
2478 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
2479 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
2480 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
2481 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
2482 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
2483 }
2484
2485 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
2486
2487
2488
2489 static void x_append_glyph_string_lists P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2490 struct glyph_string **,
2491 struct glyph_string *,
2492 struct glyph_string *));
2493 static void x_prepend_glyph_string_lists P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2494 struct glyph_string **,
2495 struct glyph_string *,
2496 struct glyph_string *));
2497 static void x_append_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2498 struct glyph_string **,
2499 struct glyph_string *));
2500 static int x_left_overwritten P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2501 static int x_left_overwriting P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2502 static int x_right_overwritten P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2503 static int x_right_overwriting P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2504 static int x_fill_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int,
2505 int));
2506 static void x_init_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2507 XChar2b *, struct window *,
2508 struct glyph_row *,
2509 enum glyph_row_area, int,
2510 enum draw_glyphs_face));
2511 static int x_draw_glyphs P_ ((struct window *, int , struct glyph_row *,
2512 enum glyph_row_area, int, int,
2513 enum draw_glyphs_face, int *, int *, int));
2514 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2515 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2516 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2517 int));
2518 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2519 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2520 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2521 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2522 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2523 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2524 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2525 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2526 static void x_get_glyph_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph *, struct frame *,
2527 int *, int *));
2528 static void x_compute_overhangs_and_x P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int));
2529 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
2530 unsigned long *, double, int));
2531 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
2532 double, int, unsigned long));
2533 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2534 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2535 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2536 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2537 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
2538 static void x_fill_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2539 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
2540 int, int, int));
2541 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
2542 int, int, int, int, XRectangle *));
2543 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
2544 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
2545 static void x_fix_overlapping_area P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
2546 enum glyph_row_area));
2547 static int x_fill_stretch_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2548 struct glyph_row *,
2549 enum glyph_row_area, int, int));
2550
2551 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
2552 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
2553 #endif
2554
2555
2556 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
2557 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
2558
2559 static INLINE void
2560 x_append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, h, t)
2561 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2562 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
2563 {
2564 if (h)
2565 {
2566 if (*head)
2567 (*tail)->next = h;
2568 else
2569 *head = h;
2570 h->prev = *tail;
2571 *tail = t;
2572 }
2573 }
2574
2575
2576 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
2577 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
2578 result. */
2579
2580 static INLINE void
2581 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, h, t)
2582 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2583 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
2584 {
2585 if (h)
2586 {
2587 if (*head)
2588 (*head)->prev = t;
2589 else
2590 *tail = t;
2591 t->next = *head;
2592 *head = h;
2593 }
2594 }
2595
2596
2597 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
2598 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
2599
2600 static INLINE void
2601 x_append_glyph_string (head, tail, s)
2602 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2603 struct glyph_string *s;
2604 {
2605 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
2606 x_append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
2607 }
2608
2609
2610 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
2611 face. */
2612
2613 static void
2614 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
2615 struct glyph_string *s;
2616 {
2617 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
2618 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
2619 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
2620 && !s->cmp)
2621 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
2622 else
2623 {
2624 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
2625 XGCValues xgcv;
2626 unsigned long mask;
2627
2628 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
2629 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
2630
2631 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
2632 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2633 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2634 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2635 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
2636 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2637 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2638
2639 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
2640 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
2641 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
2642 {
2643 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
2644 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
2645 }
2646
2647 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
2648 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
2649 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2650 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
2651
2652 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
2653 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
2654 mask, &xgcv);
2655 else
2656 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
2657 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
2658
2659 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
2660 }
2661 }
2662
2663
2664 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
2665
2666 static void
2667 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
2668 struct glyph_string *s;
2669 {
2670 int face_id;
2671 struct face *face;
2672
2673 /* What face has to be used for the mouse face? */
2674 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
2675 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
2676 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2677 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
2678 else
2679 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
2680 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
2681 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
2682
2683 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
2684 if (s->font == s->face->font)
2685 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2686 else
2687 {
2688 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
2689 but font FONT. */
2690 XGCValues xgcv;
2691 unsigned long mask;
2692
2693 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
2694 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2695 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
2696 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
2697 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2698 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
2699
2700 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
2701 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
2702 mask, &xgcv);
2703 else
2704 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
2705 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
2706
2707 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
2708 }
2709
2710 xassert (s->gc != 0);
2711 }
2712
2713
2714 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
2715 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
2716 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
2717
2718 static INLINE void
2719 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
2720 struct glyph_string *s;
2721 {
2722 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2723 }
2724
2725
2726 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
2727 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
2728 pattern. */
2729
2730 static INLINE void
2731 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
2732 struct glyph_string *s;
2733 {
2734 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
2735
2736 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
2737 {
2738 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2739 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2740 }
2741 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
2742 {
2743 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
2744 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2745 }
2746 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2747 {
2748 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
2749 s->stippled_p = 0;
2750 }
2751 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
2752 {
2753 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2754 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2755 }
2756 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2757 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2758 {
2759 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2760 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2761 }
2762 else
2763 {
2764 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2765 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2766 }
2767
2768 /* GC must have been set. */
2769 xassert (s->gc != 0);
2770 }
2771
2772
2773 /* Return in *R the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2774
2775 static void
2776 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, r)
2777 struct glyph_string *s;
2778 XRectangle *r;
2779 {
2780 if (s->row->full_width_p)
2781 {
2782 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left. */
2783 int canon_x = CANON_X_UNIT (s->f);
2784
2785 r->x = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN (s->w) * canon_x;
2786 r->width = XFASTINT (s->w->width) * canon_x;
2787
2788 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (s->f))
2789 {
2790 int width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (s->f) * canon_x;
2791 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_LEFT (s->f))
2792 r->x -= width;
2793 }
2794
2795 r->x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (s->f);
2796
2797 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
2798 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
2799 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2800 r->height = s->row->visible_height;
2801 else
2802 r->height = s->height;
2803 }
2804 else
2805 {
2806 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
2807 r->x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->area, 0);
2808 r->width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
2809 r->height = s->row->visible_height;
2810 }
2811
2812 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
2813 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
2814 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
2815 if (!s->row->full_width_p
2816 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
2817 r->y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2818 else
2819 r->y = max (0, s->row->y);
2820
2821 /* If drawing a tool-bar window, draw it over the internal border
2822 at the top of the window. */
2823 if (s->w == XWINDOW (s->f->tool_bar_window))
2824 r->y -= s->f->output_data.x->internal_border_width;
2825
2826 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
2827 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
2828 intentionally draws over other lines. */
2829 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2830 {
2831 r->y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2832 r->height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r->y;
2833 }
2834
2835 r->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r->y);
2836 }
2837
2838
2839 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
2840 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
2841
2842 static INLINE void
2843 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
2844 struct glyph_string *s;
2845 {
2846 XRectangle r;
2847 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2848 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2849 }
2850
2851
2852 /* Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
2853 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
2854
2855 static INLINE void
2856 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
2857 struct glyph_string *s;
2858 {
2859 if (s->cmp == NULL
2860 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2861 {
2862 XCharStruct cs;
2863 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
2864 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
2865 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
2866 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
2867 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
2868 }
2869 }
2870
2871
2872 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
2873 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
2874 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
2875
2876 static void
2877 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (s, x, backward_p)
2878 struct glyph_string *s;
2879 int x;
2880 int backward_p;
2881 {
2882 if (backward_p)
2883 {
2884 while (s)
2885 {
2886 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
2887 x -= s->width;
2888 s->x = x;
2889 s = s->prev;
2890 }
2891 }
2892 else
2893 {
2894 while (s)
2895 {
2896 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
2897 s->x = x;
2898 x += s->width;
2899 s = s->next;
2900 }
2901 }
2902 }
2903
2904
2905 /* Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
2906 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
2907 assumed to be zero. */
2908
2909 static void
2910 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyph, f, left, right)
2911 struct glyph *glyph;
2912 struct frame *f;
2913 int *left, *right;
2914 {
2915 *left = *right = 0;
2916
2917 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2918 {
2919 XFontStruct *font;
2920 struct face *face;
2921 struct font_info *font_info;
2922 XChar2b char2b;
2923 XCharStruct *pcm;
2924
2925 face = x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
2926 font = face->font;
2927 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
2928 if (font
2929 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
2930 {
2931 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
2932 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
2933 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
2934 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
2935 }
2936 }
2937 }
2938
2939
2940 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
2941 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
2942 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
2943
2944 static int
2945 x_left_overwritten (s)
2946 struct glyph_string *s;
2947 {
2948 int k;
2949
2950 if (s->left_overhang)
2951 {
2952 int x = 0, i;
2953 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
2954 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
2955
2956 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
2957 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
2958
2959 k = i + 1;
2960 }
2961 else
2962 k = -1;
2963
2964 return k;
2965 }
2966
2967
2968 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
2969 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
2970 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
2971
2972 static int
2973 x_left_overwriting (s)
2974 struct glyph_string *s;
2975 {
2976 int i, k, x;
2977 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
2978 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
2979
2980 k = -1;
2981 x = 0;
2982 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2983 {
2984 int left, right;
2985 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
2986 if (x + right > 0)
2987 k = i;
2988 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
2989 }
2990
2991 return k;
2992 }
2993
2994
2995 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
2996 not overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
2997 no such glyph is found. */
2998
2999 static int
3000 x_right_overwritten (s)
3001 struct glyph_string *s;
3002 {
3003 int k = -1;
3004
3005 if (s->right_overhang)
3006 {
3007 int x = 0, i;
3008 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3009 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
3010 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
3011
3012 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
3013 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3014
3015 k = i;
3016 }
3017
3018 return k;
3019 }
3020
3021
3022 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
3023 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
3024 if no such glyph is found. */
3025
3026 static int
3027 x_right_overwriting (s)
3028 struct glyph_string *s;
3029 {
3030 int i, k, x;
3031 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
3032 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3033 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
3034
3035 k = -1;
3036 x = 0;
3037 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
3038 {
3039 int left, right;
3040 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
3041 if (x - left < 0)
3042 k = i;
3043 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3044 }
3045
3046 return k;
3047 }
3048
3049
3050 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
3051
3052 static INLINE void
3053 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
3054 struct glyph_string *s;
3055 int x, y, w, h;
3056 {
3057 XGCValues xgcv;
3058 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
3059 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
3060 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
3061 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3062 }
3063
3064
3065 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
3066 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
3067 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
3068 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
3069 contains the first component of a composition. */
3070
3071 static void
3072 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
3073 struct glyph_string *s;
3074 int force_p;
3075 {
3076 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
3077 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
3078 if (!s->background_filled_p)
3079 {
3080 if (s->stippled_p)
3081 {
3082 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
3083 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
3084 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
3085 s->y + s->face->box_line_width,
3086 s->background_width,
3087 s->height - 2 * s->face->box_line_width);
3088 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
3089 s->background_filled_p = 1;
3090 }
3091 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * s->face->box_line_width
3092 || s->font_not_found_p
3093 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
3094 || force_p)
3095 {
3096 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + s->face->box_line_width,
3097 s->background_width,
3098 s->height - 2 * s->face->box_line_width);
3099 s->background_filled_p = 1;
3100 }
3101 }
3102 }
3103
3104
3105 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
3106
3107 static void
3108 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
3109 struct glyph_string *s;
3110 {
3111 int i, x;
3112
3113 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
3114 of S to the right of that box line. */
3115 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3116 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3117 x = s->x + s->face->box_line_width;
3118 else
3119 x = s->x;
3120
3121 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
3122 loaded. */
3123 if (s->font_not_found_p)
3124 {
3125 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
3126 {
3127 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
3128 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
3129 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
3130 s->height - 1);
3131 x += g->pixel_width;
3132 }
3133 }
3134 else
3135 {
3136 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
3137 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
3138
3139 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
3140 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
3141
3142 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
3143 if (!s->two_byte_p)
3144 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
3145 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
3146
3147 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
3148 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
3149 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
3150 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
3151 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
3152 if (s->for_overlaps_p
3153 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
3154 {
3155 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
3156 if (s->two_byte_p)
3157 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3158 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3159 else
3160 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3161 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3162 }
3163 else
3164 {
3165 if (s->two_byte_p)
3166 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3167 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3168 else
3169 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3170 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3171 }
3172 }
3173 }
3174
3175 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
3176
3177 static void
3178 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
3179 struct glyph_string *s;
3180 {
3181 int i, x;
3182
3183 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
3184 of S to the right of that box line. */
3185 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3186 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3187 x = s->x + s->face->box_line_width;
3188 else
3189 x = s->x;
3190
3191 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
3192 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
3193 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
3194 this composition. */
3195
3196 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
3197 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
3198 if (s->font_not_found_p)
3199 {
3200 if (s->gidx == 0)
3201 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
3202 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
3203 }
3204 else
3205 {
3206 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
3207 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3208 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
3209 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
3210 s->char2b + i, 1);
3211 }
3212 }
3213
3214
3215 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3216
3217 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
3218
3219
3220 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
3221 cannot be determined. */
3222
3223 static struct frame *
3224 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
3225 Widget widget;
3226 {
3227 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3228 Lisp_Object tail;
3229 struct frame *f;
3230
3231 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
3232
3233 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
3234 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
3235 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
3236 x_any_window_to_frame. */
3237 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
3238 widget = XtParent (widget);
3239
3240 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
3241 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
3242 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3243 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
3244 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
3245 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
3246 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
3247 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
3248 return f;
3249
3250 abort ();
3251 }
3252
3253
3254 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
3255 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
3256 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
3257 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
3258
3259 int
3260 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
3261 Widget widget;
3262 Colormap cmap;
3263 XColor *color;
3264 {
3265 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
3266 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
3267 }
3268
3269
3270 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
3271 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
3272 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
3273 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
3274 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
3275 Value is non-zero if successful. */
3276
3277 int
3278 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
3279 Widget widget;
3280 Display *display;
3281 Colormap cmap;
3282 unsigned long *pixel;
3283 double factor;
3284 int delta;
3285 {
3286 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
3287 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
3288 }
3289
3290
3291 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3292
3293
3294 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
3295 color map of frame F. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
3296 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
3297 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
3298
3299 static const XColor *
3300 x_color_cells (f, ncells)
3301 struct frame *f;
3302 int *ncells;
3303 {
3304 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3305
3306 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
3307 {
3308 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3309 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (f);
3310 int i;
3311
3312 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
3313 = XDisplayCells (display, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
3314 dpyinfo->color_cells
3315 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
3316 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
3317
3318 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
3319 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
3320
3321 XQueryColors (display, FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
3322 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
3323 }
3324
3325 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
3326 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
3327 }
3328
3329
3330 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
3331 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
3332
3333 void
3334 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
3335 struct frame *f;
3336 XColor *colors;
3337 int ncolors;
3338 {
3339 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3340
3341 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
3342 {
3343 int i;
3344 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
3345 {
3346 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
3347 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
3348 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
3349 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
3350 }
3351 }
3352 else
3353 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
3354 }
3355
3356
3357 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
3358 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
3359
3360 void
3361 x_query_color (f, color)
3362 struct frame *f;
3363 XColor *color;
3364 {
3365 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
3366 }
3367
3368
3369 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on SCREEN of DISPLAY, colormap
3370 CMAP. If an exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color
3371 available. Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the
3372 color allocated. */
3373
3374 int
3375 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
3376 struct frame *f;
3377 Colormap cmap;
3378 XColor *color;
3379 {
3380 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3381 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (f);
3382 int rc;
3383
3384 gamma_correct (f, color);
3385 rc = XAllocColor (display, cmap, color);
3386 if (rc == 0)
3387 {
3388 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
3389 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
3390 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
3391 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
3392 int nearest, i;
3393 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
3394 int ncells;
3395 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (f, &ncells);
3396
3397 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
3398 {
3399 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
3400 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
3401 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
3402 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
3403
3404 if (delta < nearest_delta)
3405 {
3406 nearest = i;
3407 nearest_delta = delta;
3408 }
3409 }
3410
3411 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
3412 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
3413 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
3414 rc = XAllocColor (display, cmap, color);
3415 }
3416 else
3417 {
3418 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
3419 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
3420 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
3421 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3422 XColor *cached_color;
3423
3424 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
3425 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
3426 (cached_color->red != color->red
3427 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
3428 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
3429 {
3430 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
3431 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
3432 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
3433 }
3434 }
3435
3436 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3437 if (rc)
3438 register_color (color->pixel);
3439 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
3440
3441 return rc;
3442 }
3443
3444
3445 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
3446 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
3447 get color reference counts right. */
3448
3449 unsigned long
3450 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
3451 struct frame *f;
3452 unsigned long pixel;
3453 {
3454 XColor color;
3455
3456 color.pixel = pixel;
3457 BLOCK_INPUT;
3458 x_query_color (f, &color);
3459 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
3460 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3461 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3462 register_color (pixel);
3463 #endif
3464 return color.pixel;
3465 }
3466
3467
3468 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
3469 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
3470 get color reference counts right. */
3471
3472 unsigned long
3473 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
3474 Display *dpy;
3475 Colormap cmap;
3476 unsigned long pixel;
3477 {
3478 XColor color;
3479
3480 color.pixel = pixel;
3481 BLOCK_INPUT;
3482 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
3483 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
3484 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3485 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3486 register_color (pixel);
3487 #endif
3488 return color.pixel;
3489 }
3490
3491
3492 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
3493 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
3494 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
3495 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
3496 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
3497 Value is non-zero if successful. */
3498
3499 static int
3500 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
3501 struct frame *f;
3502 Display *display;
3503 Colormap cmap;
3504 unsigned long *pixel;
3505 double factor;
3506 int delta;
3507 {
3508 XColor color, new;
3509 int success_p;
3510
3511 /* Get RGB color values. */
3512 color.pixel = *pixel;
3513 x_query_color (f, &color);
3514
3515 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
3516 xassert (factor >= 0);
3517 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
3518 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
3519 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
3520
3521 /* Try to allocate the color. */
3522 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
3523 if (success_p)
3524 {
3525 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
3526 {
3527 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
3528 delta to the RGB values. */
3529 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
3530
3531 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
3532 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
3533 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
3534 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
3535 }
3536 else
3537 success_p = 1;
3538 *pixel = new.pixel;
3539 }
3540
3541 return success_p;
3542 }
3543
3544
3545 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
3546 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
3547 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
3548 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
3549 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
3550 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
3551
3552 static void
3553 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
3554 struct frame *f;
3555 struct relief *relief;
3556 double factor;
3557 int delta;
3558 unsigned long default_pixel;
3559 {
3560 XGCValues xgcv;
3561 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
3562 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
3563 unsigned long pixel;
3564 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
3565 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
3566 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3567 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3568
3569 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
3570 xgcv.line_width = 1;
3571
3572 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
3573 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
3574 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
3575 if (relief->gc
3576 && relief->allocated_p)
3577 {
3578 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
3579 relief->allocated_p = 0;
3580 }
3581
3582 /* Allocate new color. */
3583 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
3584 pixel = background;
3585 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
3586 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
3587 {
3588 relief->allocated_p = 1;
3589 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
3590 }
3591
3592 if (relief->gc == 0)
3593 {
3594 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
3595 mask |= GCStipple;
3596 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
3597 }
3598 else
3599 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
3600 }
3601
3602
3603 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
3604
3605 static void
3606 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
3607 struct glyph_string *s;
3608 {
3609 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
3610 unsigned long color;
3611
3612 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
3613 color = s->face->box_color;
3614 else
3615 {
3616 XGCValues xgcv;
3617
3618 /* Get the background color of the face. */
3619 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
3620 color = xgcv.background;
3621 }
3622
3623 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
3624 || color != di->relief_background)
3625 {
3626 di->relief_background = color;
3627 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
3628 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
3629 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
3630 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
3631 }
3632 }
3633
3634
3635 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
3636 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
3637 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
3638 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
3639 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
3640 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
3641 when drawing. */
3642
3643 static void
3644 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
3645 raised_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
3646 struct frame *f;
3647 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
3648 XRectangle *clip_rect;
3649 {
3650 int i;
3651 GC gc;
3652
3653 if (raised_p)
3654 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
3655 else
3656 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
3657 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3658
3659 /* Top. */
3660 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3661 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3662 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
3663 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
3664
3665 /* Left. */
3666 if (left_p)
3667 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3668 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3669 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i);
3670
3671 XSetClipMask (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, None);
3672 if (raised_p)
3673 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
3674 else
3675 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
3676 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3677
3678 /* Bottom. */
3679 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3680 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3681 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
3682 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
3683
3684 /* Right. */
3685 if (right_p)
3686 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3687 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3688 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
3689
3690 XSetClipMask (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, None);
3691 }
3692
3693
3694 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
3695 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
3696 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
3697 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
3698 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
3699 rectangle to use when drawing. */
3700
3701 static void
3702 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
3703 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
3704 struct glyph_string *s;
3705 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, left_p, right_p;
3706 XRectangle *clip_rect;
3707 {
3708 XGCValues xgcv;
3709
3710 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3711 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
3712 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3713
3714 /* Top. */
3715 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3716 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
3717
3718 /* Left. */
3719 if (left_p)
3720 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3721 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
3722
3723 /* Bottom. */
3724 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3725 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
3726
3727 /* Right. */
3728 if (right_p)
3729 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3730 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
3731
3732 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3733 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
3734 }
3735
3736
3737 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
3738
3739 static void
3740 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
3741 struct glyph_string *s;
3742 {
3743 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
3744 int left_p, right_p;
3745 struct glyph *last_glyph;
3746 XRectangle clip_rect;
3747
3748 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
3749 if (s->row->full_width_p
3750 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
3751 {
3752 last_x += FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (s->f);
3753 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (s->f))
3754 last_x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (s->f) * CANON_X_UNIT (s->f);
3755 }
3756
3757 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
3758 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
3759 ? s->first_glyph
3760 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
3761
3762 width = s->face->box_line_width;
3763 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
3764 left_x = s->x;
3765 right_x = ((s->row->full_width_p
3766 ? last_x - 1
3767 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1));
3768 top_y = s->y;
3769 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
3770
3771 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
3772 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
3773 && (s->prev == NULL
3774 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
3775 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
3776 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
3777 && (s->next == NULL
3778 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
3779
3780 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
3781
3782 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
3783 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
3784 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
3785 else
3786 {
3787 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
3788 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
3789 width, raised_p, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
3790 }
3791 }
3792
3793
3794 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
3795
3796 static void
3797 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
3798 struct glyph_string *s;
3799 {
3800 int x;
3801 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
3802
3803 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
3804 right of that line. */
3805 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3806 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3807 x = s->x + s->face->box_line_width;
3808 else
3809 x = s->x;
3810
3811 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
3812 by that margin. */
3813 if (s->img->margin)
3814 {
3815 x += s->img->margin;
3816 y += s->img->margin;
3817 }
3818
3819 if (s->img->pixmap)
3820 {
3821 if (s->img->mask)
3822 {
3823 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
3824 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
3825 trust on the shape extension to be available
3826 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
3827 manually. */
3828 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
3829 | GCFunction);
3830 XGCValues xgcv;
3831 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
3832
3833 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
3834 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
3835 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
3836 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
3837 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
3838
3839 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
3840 image_rect.x = x;
3841 image_rect.y = y;
3842 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
3843 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
3844 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
3845 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
3846 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
3847 }
3848 else
3849 {
3850 unsigned long mask = GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin | GCFunction;
3851 XGCValues xgcv;
3852 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
3853
3854 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
3855 image_rect.x = x;
3856 image_rect.y = y;
3857 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
3858 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
3859 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
3860 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
3861 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
3862
3863 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
3864 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
3865 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
3866 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
3867 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
3868 nothing here for mouse-face. */
3869 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
3870 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
3871 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
3872 }
3873 }
3874 else
3875 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
3876 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
3877 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
3878 }
3879
3880
3881 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
3882
3883 static void
3884 x_draw_image_relief (s)
3885 struct glyph_string *s;
3886 {
3887 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
3888 XRectangle r;
3889 int x;
3890 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
3891
3892 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
3893 right of that line. */
3894 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3895 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3896 x = s->x + s->face->box_line_width;
3897 else
3898 x = s->x;
3899
3900 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
3901 by that margin. */
3902 if (s->img->margin)
3903 {
3904 x += s->img->margin;
3905 y += s->img->margin;
3906 }
3907
3908 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
3909 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
3910 {
3911 thick = tool_bar_button_relief > 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : 3;
3912 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
3913 }
3914 else
3915 {
3916 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
3917 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
3918 }
3919
3920 x0 = x - thick;
3921 y0 = y - thick;
3922 x1 = x + s->img->width + thick - 1;
3923 y1 = y + s->img->height + thick - 1;
3924
3925 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
3926 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
3927 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, 1, 1, &r);
3928 }
3929
3930
3931 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
3932
3933 static void
3934 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
3935 struct glyph_string *s;
3936 Pixmap pixmap;
3937 {
3938 int x;
3939 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
3940
3941 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
3942 right of that line. */
3943 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3944 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3945 x = s->face->box_line_width;
3946 else
3947 x = 0;
3948
3949 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
3950 by that margin. */
3951 if (s->img->margin)
3952 {
3953 x += s->img->margin;
3954 y += s->img->margin;
3955 }
3956
3957 if (s->img->pixmap)
3958 {
3959 if (s->img->mask)
3960 {
3961 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
3962 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
3963 trust on the shape extension to be available
3964 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
3965 manually. */
3966 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
3967 | GCFunction);
3968 XGCValues xgcv;
3969
3970 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
3971 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
3972 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
3973 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
3974 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
3975
3976 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
3977 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
3978 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
3979 }
3980 else
3981 {
3982 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
3983 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
3984
3985 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
3986 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
3987 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
3988 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
3989 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
3990 nothing here for mouse-face. */
3991 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
3992 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
3993 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
3994 }
3995 }
3996 else
3997 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
3998 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
3999 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4000 }
4001
4002
4003 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
4004 give the rectangle to draw. */
4005
4006 static void
4007 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
4008 struct glyph_string *s;
4009 int x, y, w, h;
4010 {
4011 if (s->stippled_p)
4012 {
4013 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4014 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4015 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
4016 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
4017 }
4018 else
4019 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
4020 }
4021
4022
4023 /* Draw image glyph string S.
4024
4025 s->y
4026 s->x +-------------------------
4027 | s->face->box
4028 |
4029 | +-------------------------
4030 | | s->img->margin
4031 | |
4032 | | +-------------------
4033 | | | the image
4034
4035 */
4036
4037 static void
4038 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
4039 struct glyph_string *s;
4040 {
4041 int x, y;
4042 int box_line_width = s->face->box_line_width;
4043 int margin = s->img->margin;
4044 int height;
4045 Pixmap pixmap = None;
4046
4047 height = s->height - 2 * box_line_width;
4048
4049 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
4050 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
4051 flickering. */
4052 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
4053 if (height > s->img->height
4054 || margin
4055 || s->img->mask
4056 || s->img->pixmap == 0
4057 || s->width != s->background_width)
4058 {
4059 if (box_line_width && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4060 x = s->x + box_line_width;
4061 else
4062 x = s->x;
4063
4064 y = s->y + box_line_width;
4065
4066 if (s->img->mask)
4067 {
4068 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
4069 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
4070 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
4071 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
4072 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
4073
4074 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
4075 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
4076 s->background_width,
4077 s->height, depth);
4078
4079 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
4080 pixmap. */
4081 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4082
4083 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
4084 if (s->stippled_p)
4085 {
4086 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4087 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4088 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
4089 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
4090 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
4091 }
4092 else
4093 {
4094 XGCValues xgcv;
4095 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
4096 &xgcv);
4097 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
4098 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
4099 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
4100 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4101 }
4102 }
4103 else
4104 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
4105
4106 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4107 }
4108
4109 /* Draw the foreground. */
4110 if (pixmap != None)
4111 {
4112 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
4113 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4114 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4115 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
4116 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
4117 }
4118 else
4119 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
4120
4121 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
4122 if (s->img->relief
4123 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
4124 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
4125 x_draw_image_relief (s);
4126 }
4127
4128
4129 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
4130
4131 static void
4132 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
4133 struct glyph_string *s;
4134 {
4135 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
4136 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
4137
4138 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
4139 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
4140 {
4141 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
4142 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
4143 int width = min (CANON_X_UNIT (s->f), s->background_width);
4144
4145 /* Draw cursor. */
4146 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
4147
4148 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
4149 if (width < s->background_width)
4150 {
4151 GC gc = s->face->gc;
4152 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
4153 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
4154 XRectangle r;
4155
4156 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
4157 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
4158
4159 if (s->face->stipple)
4160 {
4161 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4162 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4163 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
4164 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
4165 }
4166 else
4167 {
4168 XGCValues xgcv;
4169 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
4170 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
4171 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
4172 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
4173 }
4174 }
4175 }
4176 else
4177 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
4178 s->height);
4179
4180 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4181 }
4182
4183
4184 /* Draw glyph string S. */
4185
4186 static void
4187 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
4188 struct glyph_string *s;
4189 {
4190 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
4191 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
4192 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
4193 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
4194 {
4195 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
4196 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
4197 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
4198 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
4199 }
4200
4201 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
4202 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
4203 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4204
4205 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
4206 {
4207 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
4208 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
4209 break;
4210
4211 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
4212 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
4213 break;
4214
4215 case CHAR_GLYPH:
4216 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
4217 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4218 else
4219 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
4220 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
4221 break;
4222
4223 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
4224 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
4225 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4226 else
4227 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
4228 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
4229 break;
4230
4231 default:
4232 abort ();
4233 }
4234
4235 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
4236 {
4237 /* Draw underline. */
4238 if (s->face->underline_p)
4239 {
4240 unsigned long tem, h;
4241 int y;
4242
4243 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
4244 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
4245 h = 1;
4246
4247 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
4248 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
4249 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
4250 specs, and its default is
4251
4252 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
4253 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
4254
4255 if (XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
4256 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
4257 else if (s->face->font)
4258 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
4259 else
4260 y = s->height - h;
4261
4262 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
4263 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4264 s->x, y, s->width, h);
4265 else
4266 {
4267 XGCValues xgcv;
4268 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4269 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
4270 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4271 s->x, y, s->width, h);
4272 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4273 }
4274 }
4275
4276 /* Draw overline. */
4277 if (s->face->overline_p)
4278 {
4279 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
4280
4281 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
4282 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4283 s->width, h);
4284 else
4285 {
4286 XGCValues xgcv;
4287 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4288 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
4289 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4290 s->width, h);
4291 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4292 }
4293 }
4294
4295 /* Draw strike-through. */
4296 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
4297 {
4298 unsigned long h = 1;
4299 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
4300
4301 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
4302 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4303 s->width, h);
4304 else
4305 {
4306 XGCValues xgcv;
4307 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4308 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
4309 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4310 s->width, h);
4311 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4312 }
4313 }
4314
4315 /* Draw relief. */
4316 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
4317 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
4318 }
4319
4320 /* Reset clipping. */
4321 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4322 }
4323
4324
4325 static int x_fill_composite_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
4326 struct face **, int));
4327
4328
4329 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
4330
4331 FACES is an array of faces for all components of this composition.
4332 S->gidx is the index of the first component for S.
4333 OVERLAPS_P non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and
4334 use its physical height for clipping.
4335
4336 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
4337
4338 static int
4339 x_fill_composite_glyph_string (s, faces, overlaps_p)
4340 struct glyph_string *s;
4341 struct face **faces;
4342 int overlaps_p;
4343 {
4344 int i;
4345
4346 xassert (s);
4347
4348 s->for_overlaps_p = overlaps_p;
4349
4350 s->face = faces[s->gidx];
4351 s->font = s->face->font;
4352 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4353
4354 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
4355 S->gidx, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
4356 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
4357 ++s->nchars;
4358 for (i = s->gidx + 1; i < s->cmp->glyph_len && faces[i] == s->face; ++i)
4359 ++s->nchars;
4360
4361 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
4362 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
4363
4364 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
4365
4366 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
4367 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
4368 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
4369 characters of the glyph string. */
4370 if (s->font == NULL)
4371 {
4372 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
4373 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
4374 }
4375
4376 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4377 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
4378
4379 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4380
4381 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
4382 s->two_byte_p = 1;
4383
4384 return s->gidx + s->nchars;
4385 }
4386
4387
4388 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
4389
4390 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
4391 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
4392 OVERLAPS_P non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and
4393 use its physical height for clipping.
4394
4395 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
4396
4397 static int
4398 x_fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, start, end, overlaps_p)
4399 struct glyph_string *s;
4400 int face_id;
4401 int start, end, overlaps_p;
4402 {
4403 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
4404 int voffset;
4405 int glyph_not_available_p;
4406
4407 xassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
4408 xassert (s->nchars == 0);
4409 xassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
4410
4411 s->for_overlaps_p = overlaps_p,
4412 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
4413 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
4414 voffset = glyph->voffset;
4415
4416 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
4417
4418 while (glyph < last
4419 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
4420 && glyph->voffset == voffset
4421 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
4422 && glyph->face_id == face_id
4423 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
4424 {
4425 int two_byte_p;
4426
4427 s->face = x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
4428 s->char2b + s->nchars,
4429 &two_byte_p);
4430 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
4431 ++s->nchars;
4432 xassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
4433 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
4434 ++glyph;
4435 }
4436
4437 s->font = s->face->font;
4438 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4439
4440 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
4441 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
4442 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
4443 characters of the glyph string. */
4444 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
4445 {
4446 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
4447 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
4448 }
4449
4450 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4451 s->ybase += voffset;
4452
4453 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4454 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
4455 }
4456
4457
4458 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
4459
4460 static void
4461 x_fill_image_glyph_string (s)
4462 struct glyph_string *s;
4463 {
4464 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
4465 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
4466 xassert (s->img);
4467 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
4468 s->font = s->face->font;
4469 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
4470
4471 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4472 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
4473 }
4474
4475
4476 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
4477
4478 ROW is the glyph row in which the glyphs are found, AREA is the
4479 area within the row. START is the index of the first glyph to
4480 consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
4481
4482 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
4483
4484 static int
4485 x_fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, row, area, start, end)
4486 struct glyph_string *s;
4487 struct glyph_row *row;
4488 enum glyph_row_area area;
4489 int start, end;
4490 {
4491 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
4492 int voffset, face_id;
4493
4494 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
4495
4496 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
4497 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
4498 face_id = glyph->face_id;
4499 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
4500 s->font = s->face->font;
4501 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4502 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
4503 voffset = glyph->voffset;
4504
4505 for (++glyph;
4506 (glyph < last
4507 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
4508 && glyph->voffset == voffset
4509 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
4510 ++glyph)
4511 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
4512
4513 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4514 s->ybase += voffset;
4515
4516 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4517 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
4518 }
4519
4520
4521 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
4522 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
4523 x_init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
4524 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
4525 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
4526 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
4527 face-override for drawing S. */
4528
4529 static void
4530 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
4531 struct glyph_string *s;
4532 XChar2b *char2b;
4533 struct window *w;
4534 struct glyph_row *row;
4535 enum glyph_row_area area;
4536 int start;
4537 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
4538 {
4539 bzero (s, sizeof *s);
4540 s->w = w;
4541 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4542 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
4543 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
4544 s->char2b = char2b;
4545 s->hl = hl;
4546 s->row = row;
4547 s->area = area;
4548 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
4549 s->height = row->height;
4550 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
4551
4552 /* Display the internal border below the tool-bar window. */
4553 if (s->w == XWINDOW (s->f->tool_bar_window))
4554 s->y -= s->f->output_data.x->internal_border_width;
4555
4556 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
4557 }
4558
4559
4560 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
4561 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
4562 in the drawing area. */
4563
4564 static INLINE void
4565 x_set_glyph_string_background_width (s, start, last_x)
4566 struct glyph_string *s;
4567 int start;
4568 int last_x;
4569 {
4570 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
4571 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
4572 struct face *default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
4573
4574 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
4575 && s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
4576 && ((s->area == TEXT_AREA && s->row->fill_line_p)
4577 || s->face->background != default_face->background
4578 || s->face->stipple != default_face->stipple))
4579 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
4580
4581 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
4582 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
4583 area. */
4584 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
4585 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
4586 else
4587 s->background_width = s->width;
4588 }
4589
4590
4591 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
4592 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
4593 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
4594 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
4595 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
4596 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
4597 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4598
4599 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
4600 and below -- keep them on one line. */
4601 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
4602 do \
4603 { \
4604 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4605 x_init_glyph_string (s, NULL, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4606 START = x_fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, ROW, AREA, START, END); \
4607 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4608 s->x = (X); \
4609 } \
4610 while (0)
4611
4612
4613 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
4614 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
4615 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
4616 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
4617 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
4618 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
4619 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4620
4621 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
4622 do \
4623 { \
4624 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4625 x_init_glyph_string (s, NULL, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4626 x_fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
4627 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4628 ++START; \
4629 s->x = (X); \
4630 } \
4631 while (0)
4632
4633
4634 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
4635 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
4636 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
4637 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
4638 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
4639 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
4640 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
4641 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4642
4643 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
4644 do \
4645 { \
4646 int c, face_id; \
4647 XChar2b *char2b; \
4648 \
4649 c = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].u.ch; \
4650 face_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].face_id; \
4651 \
4652 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4653 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
4654 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4655 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4656 s->x = (X); \
4657 START = x_fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
4658 OVERLAPS_P); \
4659 } \
4660 while (0)
4661
4662
4663 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
4664 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
4665 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
4666 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
4667 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
4668 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
4669 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
4670 x-position of the drawing area. */
4671
4672 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
4673 do { \
4674 int cmp_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].u.cmp_id; \
4675 int face_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].face_id; \
4676 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (XFRAME (w->frame), face_id); \
4677 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
4678 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; \
4679 XChar2b *char2b; \
4680 struct face **faces; \
4681 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
4682 int n; \
4683 \
4684 base_face = base_face->ascii_face; \
4685 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((sizeof *char2b) * glyph_len); \
4686 faces = (struct face **) alloca ((sizeof *faces) * glyph_len); \
4687 /* At first, fill in `char2b' and `faces'. */ \
4688 for (n = 0; n < glyph_len; n++) \
4689 { \
4690 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, n); \
4691 int this_face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face, c); \
4692 faces[n] = FACE_FROM_ID (XFRAME (w->frame), this_face_id); \
4693 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (XFRAME (w->frame), c, \
4694 this_face_id, char2b + n, 1); \
4695 } \
4696 \
4697 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
4698 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
4699 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
4700 { \
4701 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4702 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b + n, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4703 x_append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
4704 s->cmp = cmp; \
4705 s->gidx = n; \
4706 s->x = (X); \
4707 \
4708 if (n == 0) \
4709 first_s = s; \
4710 \
4711 n = x_fill_composite_glyph_string (s, faces, OVERLAPS_P); \
4712 } \
4713 \
4714 ++START; \
4715 s = first_s; \
4716 } while (0)
4717
4718
4719 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
4720 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
4721 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
4722 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
4723 x-positions of the drawing area.
4724
4725 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
4726 to allocate glyph strings (because x_draw_glyphs can be called
4727 asynchronously). */
4728
4729 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
4730 do \
4731 { \
4732 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
4733 while (START < END) \
4734 { \
4735 struct glyph *first_glyph = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA] + START; \
4736 switch (first_glyph->type) \
4737 { \
4738 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
4739 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, \
4740 TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, \
4741 OVERLAPS_P); \
4742 break; \
4743 \
4744 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
4745 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, \
4746 HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X,\
4747 OVERLAPS_P); \
4748 break; \
4749 \
4750 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
4751 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, \
4752 HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X); \
4753 break; \
4754 \
4755 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
4756 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, \
4757 TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X); \
4758 break; \
4759 \
4760 default: \
4761 abort (); \
4762 } \
4763 \
4764 x_set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
4765 (X) += s->width; \
4766 } \
4767 } \
4768 while (0)
4769
4770
4771 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
4772 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
4773 face-override with the following meaning:
4774
4775 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
4776 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
4777 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
4778 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
4779 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
4780 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
4781
4782 If REAL_START is non-null, return in *REAL_START the real starting
4783 position for display. This can be different from START in case
4784 overlapping glyphs must be displayed. If REAL_END is non-null,
4785 return in *REAL_END the real end position for display. This can be
4786 different from END in case overlapping glyphs must be displayed.
4787
4788 If OVERLAPS_P is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters
4789 and clip to the physical height of ROW.
4790
4791 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
4792
4793 static int
4794 x_draw_glyphs (w, x, row, area, start, end, hl, real_start, real_end,
4795 overlaps_p)
4796 struct window *w;
4797 int x;
4798 struct glyph_row *row;
4799 enum glyph_row_area area;
4800 int start, end;
4801 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
4802 int *real_start, *real_end;
4803 int overlaps_p;
4804 {
4805 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
4806 struct glyph_string *s;
4807 int last_x, area_width;
4808 int x_reached;
4809 int i, j;
4810
4811 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
4812 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
4813 start = max (0, start);
4814 start = min (end, start);
4815 if (real_start)
4816 *real_start = start;
4817 if (real_end)
4818 *real_end = end;
4819
4820 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
4821 end of the drawing area. */
4822 if (row->full_width_p)
4823 {
4824 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
4825 or flag areas. */
4826 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4827 /* int width = FRAME_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f); */
4828 int window_left_x = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN (w) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
4829
4830 x += window_left_x;
4831 area_width = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
4832 last_x = window_left_x + area_width;
4833
4834 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
4835 {
4836 int width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
4837 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
4838 last_x += width;
4839 else
4840 x -= width;
4841 }
4842
4843 x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
4844 last_x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
4845 }
4846 else
4847 {
4848 x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, area, x);
4849 area_width = window_box_width (w, area);
4850 last_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, area, area_width);
4851 }
4852
4853 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
4854 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
4855 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
4856 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
4857 i = start;
4858 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x,
4859 overlaps_p);
4860 if (tail)
4861 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
4862 else
4863 x_reached = x;
4864
4865 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
4866 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
4867 strings built above. */
4868 if (head && !overlaps_p && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
4869 {
4870 int dummy_x = 0;
4871 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
4872
4873 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
4874 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
4875 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
4876
4877 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
4878 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
4879 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
4880 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
4881 draws over it. */
4882 i = x_left_overwritten (head);
4883 if (i >= 0)
4884 {
4885 j = i;
4886 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, j, start, h, t,
4887 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, dummy_x, last_x,
4888 overlaps_p);
4889 start = i;
4890 if (real_start)
4891 *real_start = start;
4892 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
4893 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
4894 }
4895
4896 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
4897 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
4898 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
4899 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
4900 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
4901 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
4902 strings exist. */
4903 i = x_left_overwriting (head);
4904 if (i >= 0)
4905 {
4906 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, i, start, h, t,
4907 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, dummy_x, last_x,
4908 overlaps_p);
4909 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
4910 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4911 if (real_start)
4912 *real_start = i;
4913 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
4914 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
4915 }
4916
4917 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
4918 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
4919 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
4920 over it. */
4921 i = x_right_overwritten (tail);
4922 if (i >= 0)
4923 {
4924 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, end, i, h, t,
4925 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, x, last_x,
4926 overlaps_p);
4927 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
4928 x_append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
4929 if (real_end)
4930 *real_end = i;
4931 }
4932
4933 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
4934 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
4935 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
4936 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
4937 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
4938 i = x_right_overwriting (tail);
4939 if (i >= 0)
4940 {
4941 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, end, i, h, t,
4942 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, x, last_x,
4943 overlaps_p);
4944 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
4945 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4946 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
4947 x_append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
4948 if (real_end)
4949 *real_end = i;
4950 }
4951 }
4952
4953 /* Draw all strings. */
4954 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
4955 x_draw_glyph_string (s);
4956
4957 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
4958 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
4959 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
4960 if (!row->full_width_p)
4961 {
4962 if (area > LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
4963 x_reached -= window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
4964 if (area > TEXT_AREA)
4965 x_reached -= window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
4966 }
4967
4968 return x_reached;
4969 }
4970
4971
4972 /* Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W. */
4973
4974 static void
4975 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, area)
4976 struct window *w;
4977 struct glyph_row *row;
4978 enum glyph_row_area area;
4979 {
4980 int i, x;
4981
4982 BLOCK_INPUT;
4983
4984 if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
4985 x = 0;
4986 else if (area == TEXT_AREA)
4987 x = row->x + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
4988 else
4989 x = (window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
4990 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
4991
4992 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
4993 {
4994 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
4995 {
4996 int start = i, start_x = x;
4997
4998 do
4999 {
5000 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
5001 ++i;
5002 }
5003 while (i < row->used[area]
5004 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
5005
5006 x_draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area, start, i,
5007 (row->inverse_p
5008 ? DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO : DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT),
5009 NULL, NULL, 1);
5010 }
5011 else
5012 {
5013 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
5014 ++i;
5015 }
5016 }
5017
5018 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5019 }
5020
5021
5022 /* Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
5023 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
5024 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
5025 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
5026 row being updated. */
5027
5028 static void
5029 x_write_glyphs (start, len)
5030 struct glyph *start;
5031 int len;
5032 {
5033 int x, hpos, real_start, real_end;
5034
5035 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5036 BLOCK_INPUT;
5037
5038 /* Write glyphs. */
5039
5040 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
5041 x = x_draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
5042 updated_row, updated_area,
5043 hpos, hpos + len,
5044 (updated_row->inverse_p
5045 ? DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO : DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT),
5046 &real_start, &real_end, 0);
5047
5048 /* If we drew over the cursor, note that it is not visible any more. */
5049 note_overwritten_text_cursor (updated_window, real_start,
5050 real_end - real_start);
5051
5052 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5053
5054 /* Advance the output cursor. */
5055 output_cursor.hpos += len;
5056 output_cursor.x = x;
5057 }
5058
5059
5060 /* Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
5061
5062 static void
5063 x_insert_glyphs (start, len)
5064 struct glyph *start;
5065 register int len;
5066 {
5067 struct frame *f;
5068 struct window *w;
5069 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
5070 struct glyph_row *row;
5071 struct glyph *glyph;
5072 int frame_x, frame_y, hpos, real_start, real_end;
5073
5074 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5075 BLOCK_INPUT;
5076 w = updated_window;
5077 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
5078
5079 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
5080 row = updated_row;
5081 line_height = row->height;
5082
5083 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
5084 shift_by_width = 0;
5085 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
5086 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
5087
5088 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
5089 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
5090 - output_cursor.x
5091 - shift_by_width);
5092
5093 /* Shift right. */
5094 frame_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, output_cursor.x);
5095 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
5096 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5097 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
5098 frame_x, frame_y,
5099 shifted_region_width, line_height,
5100 frame_x + shift_by_width, frame_y);
5101
5102 /* Write the glyphs. */
5103 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
5104 x_draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area, hpos, hpos + len,
5105 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, &real_start, &real_end, 0);
5106 note_overwritten_text_cursor (w, real_start, real_end - real_start);
5107
5108 /* Advance the output cursor. */
5109 output_cursor.hpos += len;
5110 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
5111 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5112 }
5113
5114
5115 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
5116 for X frames. */
5117
5118 static void
5119 x_delete_glyphs (n)
5120 register int n;
5121 {
5122 abort ();
5123 }
5124
5125
5126 /* Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
5127 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
5128 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
5129
5130 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
5131 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
5132
5133 static void
5134 x_clear_end_of_line (to_x)
5135 int to_x;
5136 {
5137 struct frame *f;
5138 struct window *w = updated_window;
5139 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
5140 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
5141
5142 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5143 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5144
5145 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
5146 {
5147 max_x = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5148 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
5149 && !w->pseudo_window_p)
5150 max_x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5151 }
5152 else
5153 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
5154 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
5155
5156 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
5157 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
5158 if (to_x == 0)
5159 return;
5160 else if (to_x < 0)
5161 to_x = max_x;
5162 else
5163 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
5164
5165 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
5166
5167 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
5168 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
5169 note_overwritten_text_cursor (w, output_cursor.hpos, -1);
5170
5171 from_x = output_cursor.x;
5172
5173 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
5174 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
5175 {
5176 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
5177 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
5178 }
5179 else
5180 {
5181 from_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, updated_area, from_x);
5182 to_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, updated_area, to_x);
5183 }
5184
5185 min_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
5186 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
5187 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
5188
5189 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
5190 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
5191 {
5192 BLOCK_INPUT;
5193 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5194 from_x, from_y, to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y,
5195 False);
5196 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5197 }
5198 }
5199
5200
5201 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
5202 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
5203
5204 static void
5205 x_clear_frame ()
5206 {
5207 struct frame *f;
5208
5209 if (updating_frame)
5210 f = updating_frame;
5211 else
5212 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5213
5214 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
5215 longer visible. */
5216 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
5217 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
5218 output_cursor.x = -1;
5219
5220 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
5221 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
5222 BLOCK_INPUT;
5223 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
5224
5225 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
5226 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
5227 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
5228
5229 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
5230 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5231 }
5232
5233
5234 \f
5235 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
5236
5237 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
5238 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
5239
5240 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
5241
5242
5243 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
5244 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
5245
5246 static int
5247 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
5248 struct timeval *result, x, y;
5249 {
5250 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
5251 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
5252 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
5253 {
5254 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
5255 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
5256 y.tv_sec += nsec;
5257 }
5258
5259 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
5260 {
5261 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
5262 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
5263 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
5264 }
5265
5266 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
5267 positive. */
5268 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
5269 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
5270
5271 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
5272 negative. */
5273 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
5274 }
5275
5276 void
5277 XTflash (f)
5278 struct frame *f;
5279 {
5280 BLOCK_INPUT;
5281
5282 {
5283 GC gc;
5284
5285 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
5286 pixels into background pixels. */
5287 {
5288 XGCValues values;
5289
5290 values.function = GXxor;
5291 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
5292 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
5293
5294 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5295 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
5296 }
5297
5298 {
5299 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
5300 int height = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_HEIGHT (f));
5301 /* Height of each line to flash. */
5302 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
5303 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
5304 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5305 int flash_right = PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5306
5307 int width;
5308
5309 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
5310 edge it is next to. */
5311 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
5312 {
5313 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
5314 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5315 break;
5316
5317 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
5318 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5319 break;
5320
5321 default:
5322 break;
5323 }
5324
5325 width = flash_right - flash_left;
5326
5327 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
5328 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
5329 {
5330 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5331 flash_left,
5332 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
5333 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f)),
5334 width, flash_height);
5335 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5336 flash_left,
5337 (height - flash_height
5338 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
5339 width, flash_height);
5340 }
5341 else
5342 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
5343 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5344 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
5345 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
5346
5347 x_flush (f);
5348
5349 {
5350 struct timeval wakeup;
5351
5352 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
5353
5354 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
5355 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
5356 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
5357 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
5358
5359 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup. */
5360 while (1)
5361 {
5362 struct timeval timeout;
5363
5364 EMACS_GET_TIME (timeout);
5365
5366 /* In effect, timeout = wakeup - timeout.
5367 Break if result would be negative. */
5368 if (timeval_subtract (&timeout, wakeup, timeout))
5369 break;
5370
5371 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
5372 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
5373 }
5374 }
5375
5376 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
5377 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
5378 {
5379 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5380 flash_left,
5381 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
5382 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f)),
5383 width, flash_height);
5384 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5385 flash_left,
5386 (height - flash_height
5387 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
5388 width, flash_height);
5389 }
5390 else
5391 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
5392 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5393 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
5394 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
5395
5396 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
5397 x_flush (f);
5398 }
5399 }
5400
5401 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5402 }
5403
5404 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
5405
5406
5407 /* Make audible bell. */
5408
5409 void
5410 XTring_bell ()
5411 {
5412 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5413
5414 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
5415 {
5416 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
5417 if (visible_bell)
5418 XTflash (f);
5419 else
5420 #endif
5421 {
5422 BLOCK_INPUT;
5423 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
5424 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
5425 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5426 }
5427 }
5428 }
5429
5430 \f
5431 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
5432 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
5433 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
5434 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
5435
5436 static void
5437 XTset_terminal_window (n)
5438 register int n;
5439 {
5440 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
5441 }
5442
5443
5444 \f
5445 /***********************************************************************
5446 Line Dance
5447 ***********************************************************************/
5448
5449 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
5450 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
5451
5452 static void
5453 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
5454 int vpos, n;
5455 {
5456 abort ();
5457 }
5458
5459
5460 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
5461
5462 static void
5463 x_scroll_run (w, run)
5464 struct window *w;
5465 struct run *run;
5466 {
5467 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5468 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
5469
5470 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
5471 without mode lines. Include in this box the flags areas to the
5472 left and right of W. */
5473 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
5474 width += FRAME_X_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
5475 x -= FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
5476
5477 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
5478 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
5479 bottom_y = y + height;
5480
5481 if (to_y < from_y)
5482 {
5483 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
5484 line at the bottom. */
5485 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
5486 height = bottom_y - from_y;
5487 else
5488 height = run->height;
5489 }
5490 else
5491 {
5492 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
5493 at the bottom. */
5494 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
5495 height = bottom_y - to_y;
5496 else
5497 height = run->height;
5498 }
5499
5500 BLOCK_INPUT;
5501
5502 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
5503 updated_window = w;
5504 x_clear_cursor (w);
5505
5506 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5507 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5508 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
5509 x, from_y,
5510 width, height,
5511 x, to_y);
5512
5513 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5514 }
5515
5516
5517 \f
5518 /***********************************************************************
5519 Exposure Events
5520 ***********************************************************************/
5521
5522 /* Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
5523 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
5524 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
5525 the entire frame. */
5526
5527 static void
5528 expose_frame (f, x, y, w, h)
5529 struct frame *f;
5530 int x, y, w, h;
5531 {
5532 XRectangle r;
5533
5534 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
5535
5536 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
5537 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5538 {
5539 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
5540 return;
5541 }
5542
5543 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
5544 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
5545 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
5546 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
5547 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
5548 {
5549 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
5550 return;
5551 }
5552
5553 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
5554 {
5555 r.x = r.y = 0;
5556 r.width = CANON_X_UNIT (f) * f->width;
5557 r.height = CANON_Y_UNIT (f) * f->height;
5558 }
5559 else
5560 {
5561 r.x = x;
5562 r.y = y;
5563 r.width = w;
5564 r.height = h;
5565 }
5566
5567 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
5568 expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
5569
5570 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
5571 {
5572 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
5573 XRectangle window_rect;
5574 XRectangle intersection_rect;
5575 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
5576
5577
5578 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
5579 window_rect.x = window_x;
5580 window_rect.y = window_y;
5581 window_rect.width = window_width;
5582 window_rect.height = window_height;
5583
5584 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&r, &window_rect, &intersection_rect))
5585 expose_window (w, &intersection_rect);
5586 }
5587
5588 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5589 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
5590 {
5591 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window);
5592 XRectangle window_rect;
5593 XRectangle intersection_rect;
5594 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
5595
5596
5597 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
5598 window_rect.x = window_x;
5599 window_rect.y = window_y;
5600 window_rect.width = window_width;
5601 window_rect.height = window_height;
5602
5603 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&r, &window_rect, &intersection_rect))
5604 expose_window (w, &intersection_rect);
5605 }
5606 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5607 }
5608
5609
5610 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
5611 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. */
5612
5613 static void
5614 expose_window_tree (w, r)
5615 struct window *w;
5616 XRectangle *r;
5617 {
5618 while (w)
5619 {
5620 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
5621 expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
5622 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
5623 expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
5624 else
5625 {
5626 XRectangle window_rect;
5627 XRectangle intersection_rect;
5628 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5629 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
5630
5631 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
5632 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width,
5633 &window_height);
5634 window_rect.x
5635 = (window_x
5636 - FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
5637 - FRAME_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f));
5638 window_rect.y = window_y;
5639 window_rect.width
5640 = (window_width
5641 + FRAME_X_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
5642 + FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f));
5643 window_rect.height
5644 = window_height + CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
5645
5646 if (x_intersect_rectangles (r, &window_rect, &intersection_rect))
5647 expose_window (w, &intersection_rect);
5648 }
5649
5650 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
5651 }
5652 }
5653
5654
5655 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
5656 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
5657
5658 static void
5659 expose_area (w, row, r, area)
5660 struct window *w;
5661 struct glyph_row *row;
5662 XRectangle *r;
5663 enum glyph_row_area area;
5664 {
5665 int x;
5666 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
5667 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
5668 struct glyph *last;
5669 int first_x;
5670
5671 /* Set x to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
5672 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
5673 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
5674 if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5675 x = 0;
5676 else if (area == TEXT_AREA)
5677 x = row->x + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5678 else
5679 x = (window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5680 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
5681
5682 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
5683 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
5684 x_draw_glyphs (w, x, row, area,
5685 0, row->used[area],
5686 row->inverse_p ? DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO : DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
5687 NULL, NULL, 0);
5688 else
5689 {
5690 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
5691 while (first < end
5692 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
5693 {
5694 x += first->pixel_width;
5695 ++first;
5696 }
5697
5698 /* Find the last one. */
5699 last = first;
5700 first_x = x;
5701 while (last < end
5702 && x < r->x + r->width)
5703 {
5704 x += last->pixel_width;
5705 ++last;
5706 }
5707
5708 /* Repaint. */
5709 if (last > first)
5710 x_draw_glyphs (w, first_x, row, area,
5711 first - row->glyphs[area],
5712 last - row->glyphs[area],
5713 row->inverse_p ? DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO : DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
5714 NULL, NULL, 0);
5715 }
5716 }
5717
5718
5719 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
5720 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
5721
5722 static void
5723 expose_line (w, row, r)
5724 struct window *w;
5725 struct glyph_row *row;
5726 XRectangle *r;
5727 {
5728 xassert (row->enabled_p);
5729
5730 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
5731 x_draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA, 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
5732 row->inverse_p ? DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO : DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
5733 NULL, NULL, 0);
5734 else
5735 {
5736 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
5737 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5738 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
5739 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
5740 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
5741 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
5742 x_draw_row_bitmaps (w, row);
5743 }
5744 }
5745
5746
5747 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
5748
5749 static int
5750 x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, r)
5751 struct window *w;
5752 XRectangle *r;
5753 {
5754 XRectangle cr, result;
5755 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
5756
5757 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
5758 if (cursor_glyph)
5759 {
5760 cr.x = w->phys_cursor.x;
5761 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
5762 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
5763 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
5764 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
5765 }
5766 else
5767 return 0;
5768 }
5769
5770
5771 /* Redraw a rectangle of window W. R is a rectangle in window
5772 relative coordinates. Call this function with input blocked. */
5773
5774 static void
5775 expose_window (w, r)
5776 struct window *w;
5777 XRectangle *r;
5778 {
5779 struct glyph_row *row;
5780 int y;
5781 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
5782 int cursor_cleared_p;
5783
5784 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
5785 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
5786 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
5787 created window. */
5788 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
5789 return;
5790
5791 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
5792 r->x, r->y, r->width, r->height));
5793
5794 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
5795 r->x = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, r->x);
5796 r->y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
5797
5798 /* Turn off the cursor. */
5799 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
5800 && x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, r))
5801 {
5802 x_clear_cursor (w);
5803 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
5804 }
5805 else
5806 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
5807
5808 /* Find the first row intersecting the rectangle R. */
5809 row = w->current_matrix->rows;
5810 y = 0;
5811 while (row->enabled_p
5812 && y < yb
5813 && y + row->height < r->y)
5814 {
5815 y += row->height;
5816 ++row;
5817 }
5818
5819 /* Display the text in the rectangle, one text line at a time. */
5820 while (row->enabled_p
5821 && y < yb
5822 && y < r->y + r->height)
5823 {
5824 expose_line (w, row, r);
5825 y += row->height;
5826 ++row;
5827 }
5828
5829 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
5830 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
5831 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
5832 row->enabled_p)
5833 && row->y < r->y + r->height)
5834 expose_line (w, row, r);
5835
5836 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
5837 {
5838 /* Draw border between windows. */
5839 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
5840
5841 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
5842 if (cursor_cleared_p)
5843 x_update_window_cursor (w, 1);
5844 }
5845 }
5846
5847
5848 /* Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
5849 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
5850 empty. */
5851
5852 static int
5853 x_intersect_rectangles (r1, r2, result)
5854 XRectangle *r1, *r2, *result;
5855 {
5856 XRectangle *left, *right;
5857 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
5858 int intersection_p = 0;
5859
5860 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
5861 if (r1->x < r2->x)
5862 left = r1, right = r2;
5863 else
5864 left = r2, right = r1;
5865
5866 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
5867 otherwise there is no intersection. */
5868 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
5869 {
5870 result->x = right->x;
5871
5872 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of the
5873 the right ends of left and right. */
5874 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
5875 - result->x);
5876
5877 /* Same game for Y. */
5878 if (r1->y < r2->y)
5879 upper = r1, lower = r2;
5880 else
5881 upper = r2, lower = r1;
5882
5883 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
5884 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
5885 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
5886 {
5887 result->y = lower->y;
5888
5889 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
5890 ends of upper and lower. */
5891 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
5892 upper->y + upper->height)
5893 - result->y);
5894 intersection_p = 1;
5895 }
5896 }
5897
5898 return intersection_p;
5899 }
5900
5901
5902
5903
5904 \f
5905 static void
5906 frame_highlight (f)
5907 struct frame *f;
5908 {
5909 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
5910 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
5911 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
5912 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
5913 BLOCK_INPUT;
5914 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5915 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
5916 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5917 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
5918 }
5919
5920 static void
5921 frame_unhighlight (f)
5922 struct frame *f;
5923 {
5924 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
5925 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
5926 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
5927 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
5928 BLOCK_INPUT;
5929 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5930 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
5931 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5932 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
5933 }
5934
5935 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
5936 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
5937 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
5938 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
5939 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
5940
5941 static void
5942 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
5943 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5944 struct frame *frame;
5945 {
5946 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
5947
5948 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
5949 {
5950 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
5951 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
5952 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
5953
5954 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
5955 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
5956
5957 #if 0
5958 selected_frame = frame;
5959 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
5960 selected_frame);
5961 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window);
5962 choose_minibuf_frame ();
5963 #endif /* ! 0 */
5964
5965 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
5966 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
5967 else
5968 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
5969 }
5970
5971 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
5972 }
5973
5974 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
5975
5976 void
5977 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
5978 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5979 {
5980 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
5981 }
5982
5983 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
5984 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
5985 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
5986
5987 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
5988 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
5989 the appropriate X display info. */
5990
5991 static void
5992 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
5993 struct frame *frame;
5994 {
5995 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
5996 }
5997
5998 static void
5999 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
6000 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6001 {
6002 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
6003
6004 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6005 {
6006 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
6007 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
6008 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
6009 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
6010 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
6011 {
6012 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
6013 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6014 }
6015 }
6016 else
6017 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
6018
6019 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
6020 {
6021 if (old_highlight)
6022 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
6023 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
6024 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
6025 }
6026 }
6027
6028
6029 \f
6030 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
6031
6032 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
6033 static void
6034 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
6035 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6036 {
6037 int min_code, max_code;
6038 KeySym *syms;
6039 int syms_per_code;
6040 XModifierKeymap *mods;
6041
6042 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
6043 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
6044 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
6045 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
6046 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
6047
6048 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
6049 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
6050 #else
6051 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
6052 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
6053 #endif
6054
6055 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
6056 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
6057 &syms_per_code);
6058 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
6059
6060 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
6061 Alt keysyms are on. */
6062 {
6063 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
6064
6065 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
6066 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
6067 {
6068 KeyCode code
6069 = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
6070
6071 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
6072 if (code == 0)
6073 continue;
6074
6075 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
6076 {
6077 int code_col;
6078
6079 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
6080 {
6081 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
6082
6083 switch (sym)
6084 {
6085 case XK_Meta_L:
6086 case XK_Meta_R:
6087 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6088 break;
6089
6090 case XK_Alt_L:
6091 case XK_Alt_R:
6092 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6093 break;
6094
6095 case XK_Hyper_L:
6096 case XK_Hyper_R:
6097 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6098 break;
6099
6100 case XK_Super_L:
6101 case XK_Super_R:
6102 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6103 break;
6104
6105 case XK_Shift_Lock:
6106 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
6107 if ((1 << row) == LockMask)
6108 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
6109 break;
6110 }
6111 }
6112 }
6113 }
6114 }
6115
6116 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
6117 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6118 {
6119 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
6120 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
6121 }
6122
6123 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
6124 make them just meta, not alt. */
6125 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6126 {
6127 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
6128 }
6129
6130 XFree ((char *) syms);
6131 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
6132 }
6133
6134 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
6135 Emacs uses. */
6136
6137 static unsigned int
6138 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
6139 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6140 unsigned int state;
6141 {
6142 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
6143 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
6144 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? meta_modifier : 0)
6145 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? alt_modifier : 0)
6146 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? super_modifier : 0)
6147 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? hyper_modifier : 0));
6148 }
6149
6150 static unsigned int
6151 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
6152 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6153 unsigned int state;
6154 {
6155 return ( ((state & alt_modifier) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
6156 | ((state & super_modifier) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
6157 | ((state & hyper_modifier) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
6158 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
6159 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
6160 | ((state & meta_modifier) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
6161 }
6162
6163 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
6164
6165 char *
6166 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
6167 KeySym keysym;
6168 {
6169 char *value;
6170
6171 BLOCK_INPUT;
6172 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
6173 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6174
6175 return value;
6176 }
6177
6178
6179 \f
6180 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
6181
6182 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
6183 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
6184 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
6185 not force the value into range. */
6186
6187 void
6188 pixel_to_glyph_coords (f, pix_x, pix_y, x, y, bounds, noclip)
6189 FRAME_PTR f;
6190 register int pix_x, pix_y;
6191 register int *x, *y;
6192 XRectangle *bounds;
6193 int noclip;
6194 {
6195 /* Arrange for the division in PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL etc. to round down
6196 even for negative values. */
6197 if (pix_x < 0)
6198 pix_x -= FONT_WIDTH ((f)->output_data.x->font) - 1;
6199 if (pix_y < 0)
6200 pix_y -= (f)->output_data.x->line_height - 1;
6201
6202 pix_x = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL (f, pix_x);
6203 pix_y = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_ROW (f, pix_y);
6204
6205 if (bounds)
6206 {
6207 bounds->width = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
6208 bounds->height = f->output_data.x->line_height;
6209 bounds->x = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_COL (f, pix_x);
6210 bounds->y = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_ROW (f, pix_y);
6211 }
6212
6213 if (!noclip)
6214 {
6215 if (pix_x < 0)
6216 pix_x = 0;
6217 else if (pix_x > FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f))
6218 pix_x = FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f);
6219
6220 if (pix_y < 0)
6221 pix_y = 0;
6222 else if (pix_y > f->height)
6223 pix_y = f->height;
6224 }
6225
6226 *x = pix_x;
6227 *y = pix_y;
6228 }
6229
6230
6231 /* Given HPOS/VPOS in the current matrix of W, return corresponding
6232 frame-relative pixel positions in *FRAME_X and *FRAME_Y. If we
6233 can't tell the positions because W's display is not up to date,
6234 return 0. */
6235
6236 int
6237 glyph_to_pixel_coords (w, hpos, vpos, frame_x, frame_y)
6238 struct window *w;
6239 int hpos, vpos;
6240 int *frame_x, *frame_y;
6241 {
6242 int success_p;
6243
6244 xassert (hpos >= 0 && hpos < w->current_matrix->matrix_w);
6245 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos < w->current_matrix->matrix_h);
6246
6247 if (display_completed)
6248 {
6249 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
6250 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
6251 struct glyph *end = glyph + min (hpos, row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
6252
6253 *frame_y = row->y;
6254 *frame_x = row->x;
6255 while (glyph < end)
6256 {
6257 *frame_x += glyph->pixel_width;
6258 ++glyph;
6259 }
6260
6261 success_p = 1;
6262 }
6263 else
6264 {
6265 *frame_y = *frame_x = 0;
6266 success_p = 0;
6267 }
6268
6269 *frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, *frame_y);
6270 *frame_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, *frame_x);
6271 return success_p;
6272 }
6273
6274
6275 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
6276
6277 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
6278 the mouse. */
6279
6280 static Lisp_Object
6281 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
6282 struct input_event *result;
6283 XButtonEvent *event;
6284 struct frame *f;
6285 {
6286 /* Make the event type no_event; we'll change that when we decide
6287 otherwise. */
6288 result->kind = mouse_click;
6289 result->code = event->button - Button1;
6290 result->timestamp = event->time;
6291 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6292 event->state)
6293 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
6294 ? up_modifier
6295 : down_modifier));
6296
6297 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
6298 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
6299 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
6300 result->arg = Qnil;
6301 return Qnil;
6302 }
6303
6304 \f
6305 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
6306 The input handler calls this.
6307
6308 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
6309 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
6310 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
6311 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
6312
6313 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
6314 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
6315
6316 static void
6317 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
6318 FRAME_PTR frame;
6319 XMotionEvent *event;
6320 {
6321 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
6322 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
6323 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
6324
6325 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
6326 {
6327 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
6328 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
6329 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
6330 }
6331
6332 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
6333 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
6334 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
6335 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
6336 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
6337 {
6338 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
6339 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
6340 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
6341 }
6342 }
6343
6344 /* This is used for debugging, to turn off note_mouse_highlight. */
6345
6346 int disable_mouse_highlight;
6347
6348
6349 \f
6350 /************************************************************************
6351 Mouse Face
6352 ************************************************************************/
6353
6354 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
6355 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
6356 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
6357 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
6358 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
6359 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
6360 date. */
6361
6362 static struct glyph *
6363 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, area)
6364 struct window *w;
6365 int x, y;
6366 int *hpos, *vpos, *area;
6367 {
6368 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
6369 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
6370 int x0, i, left_area_width;
6371
6372 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
6373 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
6374 {
6375 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
6376 if (!row->enabled_p)
6377 return NULL;
6378 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
6379 break;
6380 }
6381
6382 *vpos = i;
6383 *hpos = 0;
6384
6385 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
6386 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
6387 return NULL;
6388
6389 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
6390 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6391 {
6392 *area = TEXT_AREA;
6393 x0 = 0;
6394 }
6395 else
6396 {
6397 left_area_width = window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6398 if (x < left_area_width)
6399 {
6400 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
6401 x0 = 0;
6402 }
6403 else if (x < left_area_width + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA))
6404 {
6405 *area = TEXT_AREA;
6406 x0 = row->x + left_area_width;
6407 }
6408 else
6409 {
6410 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
6411 x0 = left_area_width + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
6412 }
6413 }
6414
6415 /* Find glyph containing X. */
6416 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
6417 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
6418 while (glyph < end)
6419 {
6420 if (x < x0 + glyph->pixel_width)
6421 {
6422 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6423 break;
6424 else if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
6425 break;
6426 }
6427
6428 x0 += glyph->pixel_width;
6429 ++glyph;
6430 }
6431
6432 if (glyph == end)
6433 return NULL;
6434
6435 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
6436 return glyph;
6437 }
6438
6439
6440 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
6441 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
6442
6443 static void
6444 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, x, y)
6445 struct window *w;
6446 int *x, *y;
6447 {
6448 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6449 {
6450 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
6451 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
6452 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6453 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH_SAFE (f);
6454 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
6455 }
6456 else
6457 {
6458 *x = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, *x);
6459 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
6460 }
6461 }
6462
6463
6464 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or top line of
6465 window W, x-position X. MODE_LINE_P non-zero means mouse is on the
6466 mode line. X is relative to the start of the text display area of
6467 W, so the width of bitmap areas and scroll bars must be subtracted
6468 to get a position relative to the start of the mode line. */
6469
6470 static void
6471 note_mode_line_highlight (w, x, mode_line_p)
6472 struct window *w;
6473 int x, mode_line_p;
6474 {
6475 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6476 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6477 Cursor cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
6478 struct glyph_row *row;
6479
6480 if (mode_line_p)
6481 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix);
6482 else
6483 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix);
6484
6485 if (row->enabled_p)
6486 {
6487 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
6488 Lisp_Object help, map;
6489 int x0;
6490
6491 /* Find the glyph under X. */
6492 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
6493 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
6494 x0 = - (FRAME_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f)
6495 + FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f));
6496 while (glyph < end
6497 && x >= x0 + glyph->pixel_width)
6498 {
6499 x0 += glyph->pixel_width;
6500 ++glyph;
6501 }
6502
6503 if (glyph < end
6504 && STRINGP (glyph->object)
6505 && XSTRING (glyph->object)->intervals
6506 && glyph->charpos >= 0
6507 && glyph->charpos < XSTRING (glyph->object)->size)
6508 {
6509 /* If we're on a string with `help-echo' text property,
6510 arrange for the help to be displayed. This is done by
6511 setting the global variable help_echo to the help string. */
6512 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (glyph->charpos),
6513 Qhelp_echo, glyph->object);
6514 if (!NILP (help))
6515 {
6516 help_echo = help;
6517 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
6518 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
6519 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
6520 }
6521
6522 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
6523 map = Fget_text_property (make_number (glyph->charpos),
6524 Qlocal_map, glyph->object);
6525 if (KEYMAPP (map))
6526 cursor = f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor;
6527 else
6528 {
6529 map = Fget_text_property (make_number (glyph->charpos),
6530 Qkeymap, glyph->object);
6531 if (KEYMAPP (map))
6532 cursor = f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor;
6533 }
6534 }
6535 }
6536
6537 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
6538 }
6539
6540
6541 /* Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
6542 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
6543 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
6544 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
6545
6546 static void
6547 note_mouse_highlight (f, x, y)
6548 struct frame *f;
6549 int x, y;
6550 {
6551 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6552 int portion;
6553 Lisp_Object window;
6554 struct window *w;
6555
6556 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
6557 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6558 if (popup_activated ())
6559 return;
6560 #endif
6561
6562 if (disable_mouse_highlight
6563 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
6564 return;
6565
6566 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
6567 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
6568 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
6569
6570 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer)
6571 return;
6572
6573 if (gc_in_progress)
6574 {
6575 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 1;
6576 return;
6577 }
6578
6579 /* Which window is that in? */
6580 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &portion, 1);
6581
6582 /* If we were displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
6583 if (! EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
6584 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6585
6586 /* Not on a window -> return. */
6587 if (!WINDOWP (window))
6588 return;
6589
6590 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
6591 w = XWINDOW (window);
6592 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
6593
6594 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
6595 buffer. */
6596 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6597 {
6598 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
6599 return;
6600 }
6601
6602 if (portion == 1 || portion == 3)
6603 {
6604 /* Mouse is on the mode or top line. */
6605 note_mode_line_highlight (w, x, portion == 1);
6606 return;
6607 }
6608 else
6609 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
6610 f->output_data.x->text_cursor);
6611
6612 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
6613 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
6614 if (/* Within text portion of the window. */
6615 portion == 0
6616 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
6617 && XFASTINT (w->last_modified) == BUF_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
6618 && (XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified)
6619 == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))))
6620 {
6621 int hpos, vpos, pos, i, area;
6622 struct glyph *glyph;
6623
6624 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
6625 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &area);
6626
6627 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
6628 if (glyph == NULL
6629 || area != TEXT_AREA
6630 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p)
6631 {
6632 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6633 return;
6634 }
6635
6636 pos = glyph->charpos;
6637 xassert (w->pseudo_window_p || BUFFERP (glyph->object));
6638
6639 /* Check for mouse-face and help-echo. */
6640 {
6641 Lisp_Object mouse_face, overlay, position;
6642 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec;
6643 int len, noverlays;
6644 struct buffer *obuf;
6645 int obegv, ozv;
6646
6647 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
6648 if (pos > BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
6649 return;
6650
6651 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
6652 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
6653 obuf = current_buffer;
6654 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
6655 obegv = BEGV;
6656 ozv = ZV;
6657 BEGV = BEG;
6658 ZV = Z;
6659
6660 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
6661 XSETINT (position, pos);
6662
6663 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec.
6664 Store the length in len. If there are more than 10, make
6665 enough space for all, and try again. */
6666 len = 10;
6667 overlay_vec = (Lisp_Object *) alloca (len * sizeof (Lisp_Object));
6668 noverlays = overlays_at (pos, 0, &overlay_vec, &len, NULL, NULL, 0);
6669 if (noverlays > len)
6670 {
6671 len = noverlays;
6672 overlay_vec = (Lisp_Object *) alloca (len * sizeof (Lisp_Object));
6673 noverlays = overlays_at (pos, 0, &overlay_vec, &len, NULL, NULL,0);
6674 }
6675
6676 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
6677 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
6678
6679 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
6680 if (! (EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
6681 && vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
6682 && vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
6683 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
6684 || hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
6685 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
6686 || hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
6687 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end)))
6688 {
6689 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
6690 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6691
6692 /* Find the highest priority overlay that has a mouse-face prop. */
6693 overlay = Qnil;
6694 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0; --i)
6695 {
6696 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
6697 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
6698 {
6699 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
6700 break;
6701 }
6702 }
6703
6704 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
6705 if (NILP (overlay))
6706 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, w->buffer);
6707
6708 /* Handle the overlay case. */
6709 if (! NILP (overlay))
6710 {
6711 /* Find the range of text around this char that
6712 should be active. */
6713 Lisp_Object before, after;
6714 int ignore;
6715
6716 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
6717 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
6718 /* Record this as the current active region. */
6719 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
6720 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
6721 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
6722 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
6723 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y);
6724 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
6725 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
6726 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
6727 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
6728 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
6729 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y);
6730 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
6731 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
6732 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
6733 &ignore, pos + 1, 1);
6734
6735 /* Display it as active. */
6736 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
6737 }
6738 /* Handle the text property case. */
6739 else if (! NILP (mouse_face))
6740 {
6741 /* Find the range of text around this char that
6742 should be active. */
6743 Lisp_Object before, after, beginning, end;
6744 int ignore;
6745
6746 beginning = Fmarker_position (w->start);
6747 XSETINT (end, (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
6748 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos)));
6749 before
6750 = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (pos + 1),
6751 Qmouse_face,
6752 w->buffer, beginning);
6753 after
6754 = Fnext_single_property_change (position, Qmouse_face,
6755 w->buffer, end);
6756 /* Record this as the current active region. */
6757 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
6758 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
6759 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
6760 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
6761 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y);
6762 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
6763 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
6764 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
6765 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
6766 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
6767 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y);
6768 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
6769 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
6770 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
6771 &ignore, pos + 1, 1);
6772
6773 /* Display it as active. */
6774 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
6775 }
6776 }
6777
6778 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
6779 {
6780 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
6781
6782 /* Check overlays first. */
6783 help = overlay = Qnil;
6784 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
6785 {
6786 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
6787 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
6788 }
6789
6790 if (!NILP (help))
6791 {
6792 help_echo = help;
6793 help_echo_window = window;
6794 help_echo_object = overlay;
6795 help_echo_pos = pos;
6796 }
6797 else
6798 {
6799 /* Try text properties. */
6800 if ((STRINGP (glyph->object)
6801 && glyph->charpos >= 0
6802 && glyph->charpos < XSTRING (glyph->object)->size)
6803 || (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
6804 && glyph->charpos >= BEGV
6805 && glyph->charpos < ZV))
6806 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (glyph->charpos),
6807 Qhelp_echo, glyph->object);
6808
6809 if (!NILP (help))
6810 {
6811 help_echo = help;
6812 help_echo_window = window;
6813 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
6814 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
6815 }
6816 }
6817 }
6818
6819 BEGV = obegv;
6820 ZV = ozv;
6821 current_buffer = obuf;
6822 }
6823 }
6824 }
6825
6826 static void
6827 redo_mouse_highlight ()
6828 {
6829 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
6830 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
6831 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
6832 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
6833 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
6834 }
6835
6836
6837 \f
6838 /***********************************************************************
6839 Tool-bars
6840 ***********************************************************************/
6841
6842 static int x_tool_bar_item P_ ((struct frame *, int, int,
6843 struct glyph **, int *, int *, int *));
6844
6845 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
6846 or -1. */
6847
6848 static int last_tool_bar_item;
6849
6850
6851 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
6852 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
6853 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
6854 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
6855 item in F->current_tool_bar_items. Value is
6856
6857 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
6858 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
6859 1 otherwise. */
6860
6861 static int
6862 x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, glyph, hpos, vpos, prop_idx)
6863 struct frame *f;
6864 int x, y;
6865 struct glyph **glyph;
6866 int *hpos, *vpos, *prop_idx;
6867 {
6868 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6869 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
6870 int area;
6871
6872 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
6873 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, &area);
6874 if (*glyph == NULL)
6875 return -1;
6876
6877 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
6878 f->current_tool_bar_items. */
6879 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
6880 return -1;
6881
6882 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
6883 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
6884 && *vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
6885 && *vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
6886 && (*vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
6887 || *hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
6888 && (*vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
6889 || *hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
6890 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
6891 return 0;
6892
6893 return 1;
6894 }
6895
6896
6897 /* Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
6898 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. EVENT_TYPE is either ButtionPress
6899 or ButtonRelase. */
6900
6901 static void
6902 x_handle_tool_bar_click (f, button_event)
6903 struct frame *f;
6904 XButtonEvent *button_event;
6905 {
6906 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6907 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
6908 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
6909 struct glyph *glyph;
6910 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
6911 int x = button_event->x;
6912 int y = button_event->y;
6913
6914 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
6915 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
6916 if (x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
6917 return;
6918
6919 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
6920 enabled_p = (XVECTOR (f->current_tool_bar_items)
6921 ->contents[prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P]);
6922 if (NILP (enabled_p))
6923 return;
6924
6925 if (button_event->type == ButtonPress)
6926 {
6927 /* Show item in pressed state. */
6928 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
6929 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
6930 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
6931 }
6932 else
6933 {
6934 Lisp_Object key, frame;
6935 struct input_event event;
6936
6937 /* Show item in released state. */
6938 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
6939 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
6940
6941 key = (XVECTOR (f->current_tool_bar_items)
6942 ->contents[prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY]);
6943
6944 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6945 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
6946 event.frame_or_window = frame;
6947 event.arg = frame;
6948 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
6949
6950 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
6951 event.frame_or_window = frame;
6952 event.arg = key;
6953 event.modifiers = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6954 button_event->state);
6955 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
6956 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6957 }
6958 }
6959
6960
6961 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
6962 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
6963 note_mouse_highlight. */
6964
6965 static void
6966 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y)
6967 struct frame *f;
6968 int x, y;
6969 {
6970 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
6971 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
6972 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6973 int hpos, vpos;
6974 struct glyph *glyph;
6975 struct glyph_row *row;
6976 int i;
6977 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
6978 int prop_idx;
6979 enum draw_glyphs_face draw = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
6980 int mouse_down_p, rc;
6981
6982 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative x(y
6983 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
6984 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
6985 {
6986 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6987 return;
6988 }
6989
6990 rc = x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
6991 if (rc < 0)
6992 {
6993 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
6994 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6995 return;
6996 }
6997 else if (rc == 0)
6998 /* On same tool-bar item as before. */
6999 goto set_help_echo;
7000
7001 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7002
7003 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
7004 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
7005 && f == last_mouse_frame
7006 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
7007 if (mouse_down_p
7008 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
7009 return;
7010
7011 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
7012 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7013
7014 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
7015 enabled_p = (XVECTOR (f->current_tool_bar_items)
7016 ->contents[prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P]);
7017 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
7018 {
7019 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
7020 image is a space. We include this is the highlighted area. */
7021 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7022 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
7023 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
7024
7025 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7026 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
7027 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
7028 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
7029 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
7030 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
7031
7032 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
7033 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
7034 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
7035 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
7036 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7037 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
7038
7039 /* Display it as active. */
7040 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, draw);
7041 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
7042 }
7043
7044 set_help_echo:
7045
7046 /* Set help_echo to a help string.to display for this tool-bar item.
7047 XTread_socket does the rest. */
7048 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
7049 help_echo_pos = -1;
7050 help_echo = (XVECTOR (f->current_tool_bar_items)
7051 ->contents[prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP]);
7052 if (NILP (help_echo))
7053 help_echo = (XVECTOR (f->current_tool_bar_items)
7054 ->contents[prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION]);
7055 }
7056
7057
7058 \f
7059 /* Find the glyph matrix position of buffer position POS in window W.
7060 *HPOS, *VPOS, *X, and *Y are set to the positions found. W's
7061 current glyphs must be up to date. If POS is above window start
7062 return (0, 0, 0, 0). If POS is after end of W, return end of
7063 last line in W. */
7064
7065 static int
7066 fast_find_position (w, pos, hpos, vpos, x, y)
7067 struct window *w;
7068 int pos;
7069 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7070 {
7071 int i;
7072 int lastcol;
7073 int maybe_next_line_p = 0;
7074 int line_start_position;
7075 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
7076 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, 0);
7077 struct glyph_row *best_row = row;
7078 int row_vpos = 0, best_row_vpos = 0;
7079 int current_x;
7080
7081 while (row->y < yb)
7082 {
7083 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7084 line_start_position = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos;
7085 else
7086 line_start_position = 0;
7087
7088 if (line_start_position > pos)
7089 break;
7090 /* If the position sought is the end of the buffer,
7091 don't include the blank lines at the bottom of the window. */
7092 else if (line_start_position == pos
7093 && pos == BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
7094 {
7095 maybe_next_line_p = 1;
7096 break;
7097 }
7098 else if (line_start_position > 0)
7099 {
7100 best_row = row;
7101 best_row_vpos = row_vpos;
7102 }
7103
7104 if (row->y + row->height >= yb)
7105 break;
7106
7107 ++row;
7108 ++row_vpos;
7109 }
7110
7111 /* Find the right column within BEST_ROW. */
7112 lastcol = 0;
7113 current_x = best_row->x;
7114 for (i = 0; i < best_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
7115 {
7116 struct glyph *glyph = best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + i;
7117 int charpos;
7118
7119 charpos = glyph->charpos;
7120 if (charpos == pos)
7121 {
7122 *hpos = i;
7123 *vpos = best_row_vpos;
7124 *x = current_x;
7125 *y = best_row->y;
7126 return 1;
7127 }
7128 else if (charpos > pos)
7129 break;
7130 else if (charpos > 0)
7131 lastcol = i;
7132
7133 current_x += glyph->pixel_width;
7134 }
7135
7136 /* If we're looking for the end of the buffer,
7137 and we didn't find it in the line we scanned,
7138 use the start of the following line. */
7139 if (maybe_next_line_p)
7140 {
7141 ++best_row;
7142 ++best_row_vpos;
7143 lastcol = 0;
7144 current_x = best_row->x;
7145 }
7146
7147 *vpos = best_row_vpos;
7148 *hpos = lastcol + 1;
7149 *x = current_x;
7150 *y = best_row->y;
7151 return 0;
7152 }
7153
7154
7155 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_*
7156 in its mouse-face if HL > 0, in its normal face if HL = 0. */
7157
7158 static void
7159 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, draw)
7160 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7161 enum draw_glyphs_face draw;
7162 {
7163 struct window *w = XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window);
7164 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7165 int i;
7166 int cursor_off_p = 0;
7167 struct cursor_pos saved_cursor;
7168
7169 saved_cursor = output_cursor;
7170
7171 /* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
7172 to do anything. */
7173 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
7174 goto set_x_cursor;
7175
7176 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
7177 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
7178 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row >= w->current_matrix->nrows)
7179 goto set_x_cursor;
7180
7181 set_output_cursor (&w->phys_cursor);
7182
7183 /* Note that mouse_face_beg_row etc. are window relative. */
7184 for (i = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row;
7185 i <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row;
7186 i++)
7187 {
7188 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
7189 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
7190
7191 /* Don't do anything if row doesn't have valid contents. */
7192 if (!row->enabled_p)
7193 continue;
7194
7195 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
7196 if (i == dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row)
7197 {
7198 start_hpos = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
7199 start_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
7200 }
7201 else
7202 {
7203 start_hpos = 0;
7204 start_x = 0;
7205 }
7206
7207 if (i == dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
7208 end_hpos = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
7209 else
7210 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
7211
7212 /* If the cursor's in the text we are about to rewrite, turn the
7213 cursor off. */
7214 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
7215 && i == output_cursor.vpos
7216 && output_cursor.hpos >= start_hpos - 1
7217 && output_cursor.hpos <= end_hpos)
7218 {
7219 x_update_window_cursor (w, 0);
7220 cursor_off_p = 1;
7221 }
7222
7223 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
7224 {
7225 row->mouse_face_p = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
7226 x_draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA,
7227 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, NULL, NULL, 0);
7228 }
7229 }
7230
7231 /* If we turned the cursor off, turn it back on. */
7232 if (cursor_off_p)
7233 x_display_cursor (w, 1,
7234 output_cursor.hpos, output_cursor.vpos,
7235 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
7236
7237 output_cursor = saved_cursor;
7238
7239 set_x_cursor:
7240
7241 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
7242 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
7243 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7244 f->output_data.x->text_cursor);
7245 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
7246 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7247 f->output_data.x->cross_cursor);
7248 else
7249 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7250 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
7251 }
7252
7253 /* Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
7254 Redraw it un-highlighted first. */
7255
7256 void
7257 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo)
7258 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7259 {
7260 if (tip_frame)
7261 return;
7262
7263 if (! NILP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
7264 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
7265
7266 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
7267 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
7268 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
7269 }
7270
7271
7272 /* Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
7273 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
7274 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
7275
7276 static void
7277 x_clear_mouse_face (w)
7278 struct window *w;
7279 {
7280 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
7281 Lisp_Object window;
7282
7283 BLOCK_INPUT;
7284 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
7285 if (EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
7286 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7287 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7288 }
7289
7290
7291 /* Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
7292 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
7293
7294 void
7295 cancel_mouse_face (f)
7296 FRAME_PTR f;
7297 {
7298 Lisp_Object window;
7299 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7300
7301 window = dpyinfo->mouse_face_window;
7302 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
7303 {
7304 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
7305 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
7306 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
7307 }
7308 }
7309 \f
7310 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar ();
7311 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion ();
7312
7313 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
7314 *fp should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
7315
7316 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *fp, *bar_window,
7317 and *part to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
7318 is over. Set *x and *y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
7319 position on the scroll bar.
7320
7321 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *fp to the frame the
7322 mouse is on, *bar_window to nil, and *x and *y to the character cell
7323 the mouse is over.
7324
7325 Set *time to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
7326 was at this position.
7327
7328 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
7329
7330 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
7331 movement. */
7332
7333 static void
7334 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
7335 FRAME_PTR *fp;
7336 int insist;
7337 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
7338 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
7339 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
7340 unsigned long *time;
7341 {
7342 FRAME_PTR f1;
7343
7344 BLOCK_INPUT;
7345
7346 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
7347 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
7348 else
7349 {
7350 Window root;
7351 int root_x, root_y;
7352
7353 Window dummy_window;
7354 int dummy;
7355
7356 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7357
7358 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
7359 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7360 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
7361 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
7362
7363 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
7364
7365 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
7366 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
7367 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
7368
7369 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
7370 &root,
7371
7372 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
7373 a different screen. */
7374 &dummy_window,
7375
7376 /* The position on that root window. */
7377 &root_x, &root_y,
7378
7379 /* More trash we can't trust. */
7380 &dummy, &dummy,
7381
7382 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
7383 we don't care. */
7384 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
7385
7386 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
7387 containing the pointer. */
7388 {
7389 Window win, child;
7390 int win_x, win_y;
7391 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
7392 int count;
7393
7394 win = root;
7395
7396 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
7397 structure is changing at the same time this function
7398 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
7399
7400 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
7401
7402 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
7403 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
7404 {
7405 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
7406 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
7407 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
7408
7409 /* From-window, to-window. */
7410 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
7411
7412 /* From-position, to-position. */
7413 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
7414
7415 /* Child of win. */
7416 &child);
7417 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
7418 }
7419 else
7420 {
7421 while (1)
7422 {
7423 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
7424
7425 /* From-window, to-window. */
7426 root, win,
7427
7428 /* From-position, to-position. */
7429 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
7430
7431 /* Child of win. */
7432 &child);
7433
7434 if (child == None || child == win)
7435 break;
7436
7437 win = child;
7438 parent_x = win_x;
7439 parent_y = win_y;
7440 }
7441
7442 /* Now we know that:
7443 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
7444 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
7445 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
7446 (XTC did this the last time through), and
7447 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
7448 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
7449 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
7450 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
7451 never use them in that case.) */
7452
7453 /* Is win one of our frames? */
7454 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
7455 }
7456
7457 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
7458 f1 = 0;
7459
7460 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
7461
7462 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
7463 if (! f1)
7464 {
7465 struct scroll_bar *bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (win);
7466
7467 if (bar)
7468 {
7469 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
7470 win_x = parent_x;
7471 win_y = parent_y;
7472 }
7473 }
7474
7475 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
7476 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
7477
7478 if (f1)
7479 {
7480 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
7481 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
7482 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
7483 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
7484 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
7485 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
7486 the frame are divided into. */
7487
7488 #if OLD_REDISPLAY_CODE
7489 int ignore1, ignore2;
7490 pixel_to_glyph_coords (f1, win_x, win_y, &ignore1, &ignore2,
7491 &last_mouse_glyph,
7492 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f1)->grabbed
7493 || insist);
7494 #else
7495 {
7496 int width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
7497 int height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
7498 int x = win_x;
7499 int y = win_y;
7500
7501 /* Arrange for the division in PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL etc. to
7502 round down even for negative values. */
7503 if (x < 0)
7504 x -= width - 1;
7505 if (y < 0)
7506 y -= height - 1;
7507
7508 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
7509 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
7510 last_mouse_glyph.x = (x + width - 1) / width * width;
7511 last_mouse_glyph.y = (y + height - 1) / height * height;
7512 }
7513 #endif
7514
7515 *bar_window = Qnil;
7516 *part = 0;
7517 *fp = f1;
7518 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
7519 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
7520 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
7521 }
7522 }
7523 }
7524
7525 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7526 }
7527
7528
7529 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7530
7531 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
7532 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
7533 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
7534 that slows us down. */
7535
7536 static void
7537 x_process_timeouts (timer)
7538 struct atimer *timer;
7539 {
7540 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated_flag)
7541 {
7542 BLOCK_INPUT;
7543 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
7544 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
7545 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7546 }
7547 }
7548
7549 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7550
7551 \f
7552 /* Scroll bar support. */
7553
7554 /* Given an X window ID, find the struct scroll_bar which manages it.
7555 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
7556 bits. */
7557
7558 static struct scroll_bar *
7559 x_window_to_scroll_bar (window_id)
7560 Window window_id;
7561 {
7562 Lisp_Object tail;
7563
7564 for (tail = Vframe_list;
7565 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
7566 tail = XCDR (tail))
7567 {
7568 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
7569
7570 frame = XCAR (tail);
7571 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
7572 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
7573 abort ();
7574
7575 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
7576 right window ID. */
7577 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
7578 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
7579 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
7580 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
7581 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
7582 condemned = Qnil,
7583 ! GC_NILP (bar));
7584 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
7585 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id)
7586 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
7587 }
7588
7589 return 0;
7590 }
7591
7592
7593 \f
7594 /************************************************************************
7595 Toolkit scroll bars
7596 ************************************************************************/
7597
7598 #if USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7599
7600 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
7601 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
7602 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
7603 struct scroll_bar *));
7604 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
7605 int, int, int));
7606
7607
7608 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
7609
7610 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
7611
7612 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
7613 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
7614
7615 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
7616
7617 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
7618
7619 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
7620
7621 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
7622 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
7623
7624 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
7625
7626 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
7627 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
7628 to avoid jerkyness. */
7629
7630 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
7631
7632
7633 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
7634 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
7635 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
7636 a `end-scroll' scroll_bar_click' event if so. */
7637
7638 static void
7639 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
7640 num_params)
7641 Widget widget;
7642 XtPointer client_data;
7643 String action_name;
7644 XEvent *event;
7645 String *params;
7646 Cardinal *num_params;
7647 {
7648 int scroll_bar_p;
7649 char *end_action;
7650
7651 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
7652 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
7653 end_action = "Release";
7654 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
7655 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
7656 end_action = "EndScroll";
7657 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
7658
7659 if (scroll_bar_p
7660 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
7661 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
7662 {
7663 struct window *w;
7664
7665 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
7666 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
7667 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
7668 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
7669 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
7670 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
7671
7672 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
7673 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
7674 }
7675 }
7676
7677
7678 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
7679 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
7680 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
7681 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
7682
7683 static void
7684 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
7685 Lisp_Object window;
7686 int part, portion, whole;
7687 {
7688 XEvent event;
7689 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
7690 struct frame *f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame);
7691
7692 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
7693 ev->type = ClientMessage;
7694 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
7695 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7696 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7697 ev->format = 32;
7698 ev->data.l[0] = (long) XFASTINT (window);
7699 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
7700 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
7701 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
7702 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
7703
7704 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
7705 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
7706
7707 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
7708 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
7709 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
7710 BLOCK_INPUT;
7711 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
7712 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7713 }
7714
7715
7716 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
7717 in *IEVENT. */
7718
7719 static void
7720 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
7721 XEvent *event;
7722 struct input_event *ievent;
7723 {
7724 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
7725 Lisp_Object window;
7726 struct frame *f;
7727
7728 XSETFASTINT (window, ev->data.l[0]);
7729 f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame);
7730
7731 ievent->kind = scroll_bar_click;
7732 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
7733 ievent->arg = Qnil;
7734 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7735 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
7736 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
7737 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
7738 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
7739 ievent->modifiers = 0;
7740 }
7741
7742
7743 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
7744
7745 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
7746
7747 #define XM_SB_MIN 1
7748 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
7749 #define XM_SB_RANGE (XM_SB_MAX - XM_SB_MIN)
7750
7751
7752 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
7753 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
7754 CALL_DATA is a pointer a a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
7755
7756 static void
7757 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
7758 Widget widget;
7759 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
7760 {
7761 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
7762 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
7763 double percent;
7764 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
7765
7766 switch (cs->reason)
7767 {
7768 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
7769 bar->dragging = Qnil;
7770 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
7771 break;
7772
7773 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
7774 bar->dragging = Qnil;
7775 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
7776 break;
7777
7778 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
7779 bar->dragging = Qnil;
7780 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
7781 break;
7782
7783 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
7784 bar->dragging = Qnil;
7785 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
7786 break;
7787
7788 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
7789 bar->dragging = Qnil;
7790 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
7791 break;
7792
7793 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
7794 bar->dragging = Qnil;
7795 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
7796 break;
7797
7798 case XmCR_DRAG:
7799 {
7800 int slider_size;
7801 int dragging_down_p = (INTEGERP (bar->dragging)
7802 && XINT (bar->dragging) <= cs->value);
7803
7804 /* Get the slider size. */
7805 BLOCK_INPUT;
7806 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
7807 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7808
7809 /* At the max position of the scroll bar, do a line-wise
7810 movement. Without doing anything, the LessTif scroll bar
7811 calls us with the same cs->value again and again. If we
7812 want to make sure that we can reach the end of the buffer,
7813 we have to do something.
7814
7815 Implementation note: setting bar->dragging always to
7816 cs->value gives a smoother movement at the max position.
7817 Setting it to nil when doing line-wise movement gives
7818 a better slider behavior. */
7819
7820 if (cs->value + slider_size == XM_SB_MAX
7821 || (dragging_down_p
7822 && last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow))
7823 {
7824 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
7825 bar->dragging = Qnil;
7826 }
7827 else
7828 {
7829 whole = XM_SB_RANGE;
7830 portion = min (cs->value - XM_SB_MIN, XM_SB_MAX - slider_size);
7831 part = scroll_bar_handle;
7832 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
7833 }
7834 }
7835 break;
7836
7837 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
7838 break;
7839 };
7840
7841 if (part >= 0)
7842 {
7843 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
7844 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
7845 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
7846 }
7847 }
7848
7849
7850 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw. */
7851
7852
7853 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
7854 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
7855 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
7856 the thumb is. */
7857
7858 static void
7859 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
7860 Widget widget;
7861 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
7862 {
7863 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
7864 float top = *(float *) call_data;
7865 float shown;
7866 int whole, portion, height;
7867 int part;
7868
7869 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
7870 BLOCK_INPUT;
7871 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
7872 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7873
7874 whole = 10000000;
7875 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
7876
7877 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
7878 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
7879 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
7880 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
7881 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
7882 bottom). */
7883 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
7884 else
7885 part = scroll_bar_handle;
7886
7887 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
7888 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
7889 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
7890 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
7891 }
7892
7893
7894 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
7895 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
7896 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
7897 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
7898 has taken place. It's magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
7899 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
7900 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
7901
7902 static void
7903 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
7904 Widget widget;
7905 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
7906 {
7907 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
7908 int position = (int) call_data;
7909 Dimension height;
7910 int part;
7911
7912 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
7913 BLOCK_INPUT;
7914 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
7915 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7916
7917 if (abs (position) >= height)
7918 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
7919
7920 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
7921 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
7922 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
7923 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
7924 else
7925 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
7926
7927 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
7928 bar->dragging = Qnil;
7929 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
7930 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
7931 }
7932
7933
7934 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
7935
7936
7937 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
7938 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
7939
7940 static void
7941 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
7942 struct frame *f;
7943 struct scroll_bar *bar;
7944 {
7945 Window xwindow;
7946 Widget widget;
7947 Arg av[20];
7948 int ac = 0;
7949 char *scroll_bar_name = "verticalScrollBar";
7950 unsigned long pixel;
7951
7952 BLOCK_INPUT;
7953
7954 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
7955 /* LessTif 0.85, problems:
7956
7957 1. When the mouse if over the scroll bar, the scroll bar will
7958 get keyboard events. I didn't find a way to turn this off.
7959
7960 2. Do we have to explicitly set the cursor to get an arrow
7961 cursor (see below)? */
7962
7963 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
7964 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
7965 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, XM_SB_MIN); ++ac;
7966 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
7967 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
7968 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
7969 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
7970 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
7971
7972 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
7973 if (pixel != -1)
7974 {
7975 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
7976 ++ac;
7977 }
7978
7979 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
7980 if (pixel != -1)
7981 {
7982 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
7983 ++ac;
7984 }
7985
7986 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
7987 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
7988
7989 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
7990 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
7991 (XtPointer) bar);
7992 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
7993 (XtPointer) bar);
7994 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
7995 (XtPointer) bar);
7996 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
7997 (XtPointer) bar);
7998 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
7999 (XtPointer) bar);
8000 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8001 (XtPointer) bar);
8002 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8003 (XtPointer) bar);
8004
8005 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
8006 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
8007
8008 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
8009 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
8010 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
8011 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
8012
8013 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
8014
8015 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
8016 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
8017 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
8018 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
8019 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
8020 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
8021 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
8022 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
8023 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True); ++ac; */
8024
8025 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
8026 if (pixel != -1)
8027 {
8028 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
8029 ++ac;
8030 }
8031
8032 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8033 if (pixel != -1)
8034 {
8035 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
8036 ++ac;
8037 }
8038
8039 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
8040 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
8041
8042 {
8043 char *initial = "";
8044 char *val = initial;
8045 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
8046 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
8047 if (val == initial)
8048 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
8049 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
8050 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
8051 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
8052 }
8053 }
8054
8055 /* Define callbacks. */
8056 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
8057 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
8058 (XtPointer) bar);
8059
8060 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
8061 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
8062
8063 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
8064
8065 /* Install an action hook that let's us detect when the user
8066 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
8067 if (action_hook_id == 0)
8068 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
8069
8070 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
8071 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
8072 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
8073 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
8074
8075 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8076 }
8077
8078
8079 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
8080 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
8081
8082 static void
8083 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
8084 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8085 int portion, position, whole;
8086 {
8087 float top, shown;
8088 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar);
8089
8090 if (whole == 0)
8091 top = 0, shown = 1;
8092 else
8093 {
8094 top = (float) position / whole;
8095 shown = (float) portion / whole;
8096 }
8097
8098 BLOCK_INPUT;
8099
8100 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8101 {
8102 int size, value;
8103 Boolean arrow1_selected, arrow2_selected;
8104 unsigned char flags;
8105 XmScrollBarWidget sb;
8106
8107 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
8108 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
8109 value. */
8110 size = shown * XM_SB_RANGE;
8111 size = min (size, XM_SB_RANGE);
8112 size = max (size, 1);
8113
8114 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
8115 value = top * XM_SB_RANGE;
8116 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
8117 value = max (value, XM_SB_MIN);
8118
8119 /* LessTif: Calling XmScrollBarSetValues after an increment or
8120 decrement turns off auto-repeat LessTif-internally. This can
8121 be seen in ScrollBar.c which resets Arrow1Selected and
8122 Arrow2Selected. It also sets internal flags so that LessTif
8123 believes the mouse is in the slider. We either have to change
8124 our code, or work around that by accessing private data. */
8125
8126 sb = (XmScrollBarWidget) widget;
8127 arrow1_selected = sb->scrollBar.arrow1_selected;
8128 arrow2_selected = sb->scrollBar.arrow2_selected;
8129 flags = sb->scrollBar.flags;
8130
8131 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
8132 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
8133 else if (last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
8134 /* This has the negative side effect that the slider value is
8135 not what it would be if we scrolled here using line-wise or
8136 page-wise movement. */
8137 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, XM_SB_RANGE - value, 0, 0, False);
8138 else
8139 {
8140 /* If currently dragging, only update the slider size.
8141 This reduces flicker effects. */
8142 int old_value, old_size, increment, page_increment;
8143
8144 XmScrollBarGetValues (widget, &old_value, &old_size,
8145 &increment, &page_increment);
8146 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, old_value,
8147 min (size, XM_SB_RANGE - old_value),
8148 0, 0, False);
8149 }
8150
8151 sb->scrollBar.arrow1_selected = arrow1_selected;
8152 sb->scrollBar.arrow2_selected = arrow2_selected;
8153 sb->scrollBar.flags = flags;
8154 }
8155 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
8156 {
8157 float old_top, old_shown;
8158 Dimension height;
8159 XtVaGetValues (widget,
8160 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
8161 XtNshown, &old_shown,
8162 XtNheight, &height,
8163 NULL);
8164
8165 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
8166 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
8167 top = max (0, min (1, top));
8168 else
8169 top = old_top;
8170 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
8171 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
8172
8173 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
8174 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
8175 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
8176 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
8177 {
8178 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
8179 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
8180 else
8181 {
8182 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
8183 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
8184 int scroll_mode = 0;
8185
8186 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
8187 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
8188 {
8189 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
8190 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
8191 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
8192 if (scroll_mode == 2)
8193 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
8194 }
8195 #endif
8196 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
8197 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
8198 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
8199
8200 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
8201
8202 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
8203 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
8204 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
8205 #endif
8206 }
8207 }
8208 }
8209 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
8210
8211 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8212 }
8213
8214 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8215
8216
8217 \f
8218 /************************************************************************
8219 Scroll bars, general
8220 ************************************************************************/
8221
8222 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
8223 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
8224 WIDTH and HEIGHT are.the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
8225 scroll bar. */
8226
8227 static struct scroll_bar *
8228 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
8229 struct window *w;
8230 int top, left, width, height;
8231 {
8232 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8233 struct scroll_bar *bar
8234 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
8235
8236 BLOCK_INPUT;
8237
8238 #if USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8239 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
8240 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8241 {
8242 XSetWindowAttributes a;
8243 unsigned long mask;
8244 Window window;
8245
8246 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8247 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
8248 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
8249
8250 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
8251 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
8252 | ExposureMask);
8253 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
8254
8255 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
8256
8257 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
8258 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
8259 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
8260 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8261 left, top, width,
8262 window_box_height (w), False);
8263
8264 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8265 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
8266 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
8267 top,
8268 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
8269 height,
8270 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
8271 0,
8272 CopyFromParent,
8273 CopyFromParent,
8274 CopyFromParent,
8275 /* Attributes. */
8276 mask, &a);
8277 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
8278 }
8279 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8280
8281 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
8282 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
8283 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
8284 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
8285 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
8286 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
8287 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
8288 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8289
8290 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
8291 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
8292 bar->prev = Qnil;
8293 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
8294 if (!NILP (bar->next))
8295 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
8296
8297 /* Map the window/widget. */
8298 #if USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8299 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar),
8300 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
8301 top,
8302 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
8303 height, 0);
8304 XtMapWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar));
8305 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8306 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
8307 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8308
8309 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8310 return bar;
8311 }
8312
8313
8314 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
8315
8316 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
8317 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
8318 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
8319 events.)
8320
8321 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
8322 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
8323 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
8324 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
8325 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
8326
8327 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8328
8329 static void
8330 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
8331 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8332 int start, end;
8333 int rebuild;
8334 {
8335 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
8336 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
8337 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
8338 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
8339
8340 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
8341 if (! rebuild
8342 && start == XINT (bar->start)
8343 && end == XINT (bar->end))
8344 return;
8345
8346 BLOCK_INPUT;
8347
8348 {
8349 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
8350 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
8351 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
8352
8353 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
8354 the distance between start and end. */
8355 {
8356 int length = end - start;
8357
8358 if (start < 0)
8359 start = 0;
8360 else if (start > top_range)
8361 start = top_range;
8362 end = start + length;
8363
8364 if (end < start)
8365 end = start;
8366 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
8367 end = top_range;
8368 }
8369
8370 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
8371 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
8372 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
8373
8374 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
8375 if (end > top_range)
8376 end = top_range;
8377
8378 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
8379 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
8380 that many pixels tall. */
8381 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
8382
8383 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
8384 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
8385 if (0 < start)
8386 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
8387
8388 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
8389 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
8390 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
8391 inside_width, start,
8392 False);
8393
8394 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
8395 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8396 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
8397 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8398
8399 /* Draw the handle itself. */
8400 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
8401
8402 /* x, y, width, height */
8403 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
8404 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
8405 inside_width, end - start);
8406
8407 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
8408 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8409 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
8410 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8411
8412 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
8413 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
8414 if (end < inside_height)
8415 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
8416
8417 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
8418 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
8419 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
8420 inside_width, inside_height - end,
8421 False);
8422
8423 }
8424
8425 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8426 }
8427
8428 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8429
8430 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
8431 nil. */
8432
8433 static void
8434 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
8435 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8436 {
8437 BLOCK_INPUT;
8438
8439 #if USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8440 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar));
8441 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8442 {
8443 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
8444 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
8445 }
8446 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8447
8448 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
8449 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
8450
8451 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8452 }
8453
8454
8455 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
8456 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
8457 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
8458 create one. */
8459
8460 static void
8461 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
8462 struct window *w;
8463 int portion, whole, position;
8464 {
8465 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8466 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8467 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
8468 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
8469
8470 /* Get window dimensions. */
8471 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
8472 top = window_y;
8473 width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
8474 height = window_height;
8475
8476 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
8477 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
8478 left = XINT (w->left) + XINT (w->width) - FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f);
8479 else
8480 left = XFASTINT (w->left);
8481 left *= CANON_X_UNIT (f);
8482 left += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
8483
8484 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
8485 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
8486 if (FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8487 sb_width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8488 else
8489 sb_width = width;
8490
8491 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
8492 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8493 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
8494 sb_left = left + width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2;
8495 else
8496 sb_left = left + (width - sb_width) / 2;
8497 #else
8498 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
8499 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
8500 else
8501 sb_left = left;
8502 #endif
8503
8504 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
8505 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
8506 {
8507 BLOCK_INPUT;
8508 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8509 left, top, width, height, False);
8510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8511 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
8512 }
8513 else
8514 {
8515 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
8516 unsigned int mask = 0;
8517
8518 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
8519
8520 BLOCK_INPUT;
8521
8522 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
8523 mask |= CWX;
8524 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
8525 mask |= CWY;
8526 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
8527 mask |= CWWidth;
8528 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
8529 mask |= CWHeight;
8530
8531 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8532
8533 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
8534 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
8535 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8536 left, top, width, height, False);
8537
8538 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
8539 if (mask)
8540 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar),
8541 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
8542 top,
8543 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
8544 height, 0);
8545
8546 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8547
8548 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
8549 {
8550 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar. This makes sure a
8551 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
8552 example. Non-toolkit scroll bars are as wide as the area
8553 reserved for scroll bars - trim at both sides. */
8554 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8555 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
8556 height, False);
8557 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8558 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
8559 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
8560 height, False);
8561 }
8562
8563 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
8564 if (mask)
8565 {
8566 XWindowChanges wc;
8567
8568 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
8569 wc.y = top;
8570 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
8571 wc.height = height;
8572 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
8573 mask, &wc);
8574 }
8575
8576 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8577
8578 /* Remember new settings. */
8579 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
8580 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
8581 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
8582 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
8583
8584 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8585 }
8586
8587 #if USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8588 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
8589 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8590 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
8591 dragged. */
8592 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
8593 {
8594 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
8595
8596 if (whole == 0)
8597 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
8598 else
8599 {
8600 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
8601 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
8602 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
8603 }
8604 }
8605 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8606
8607 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
8608 }
8609
8610
8611 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
8612 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
8613 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
8614 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
8615 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
8616 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
8617 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
8618
8619 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
8620 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
8621 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
8622
8623 static void
8624 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
8625 FRAME_PTR frame;
8626 {
8627 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
8628 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
8629 {
8630 Lisp_Object bar;
8631 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
8632 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
8633 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
8634 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
8635 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
8636 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
8637 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
8638 }
8639 }
8640
8641
8642 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
8643 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
8644
8645 static void
8646 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
8647 struct window *window;
8648 {
8649 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8650 struct frame *f;
8651
8652 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
8653 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
8654 abort ();
8655
8656 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
8657
8658 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
8659 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
8660 if (NILP (bar->prev))
8661 {
8662 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
8663 the lists. */
8664 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
8665 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
8666 return;
8667 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
8668 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
8669 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
8670 else
8671 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
8672 one or the other! */
8673 abort ();
8674 }
8675 else
8676 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
8677
8678 if (! NILP (bar->next))
8679 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
8680
8681 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
8682 bar->prev = Qnil;
8683 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
8684 if (! NILP (bar->next))
8685 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
8686 }
8687
8688 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
8689 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
8690
8691 static void
8692 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
8693 FRAME_PTR f;
8694 {
8695 Lisp_Object bar, next;
8696
8697 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
8698
8699 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
8700 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
8701 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
8702
8703 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
8704 {
8705 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8706
8707 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8708
8709 next = b->next;
8710 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
8711 }
8712
8713 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
8714 and they should get garbage-collected. */
8715 }
8716
8717
8718 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
8719 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
8720
8721 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
8722 mark bits. */
8723
8724 static void
8725 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
8726 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8727 XEvent *event;
8728 {
8729 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8730
8731 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
8732 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
8733 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
8734 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
8735
8736 BLOCK_INPUT;
8737
8738 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
8739
8740 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
8741 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
8742
8743 /* x, y, width, height */
8744 0, 0,
8745 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
8746 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
8747
8748 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8749
8750 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8751 }
8752
8753 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
8754 is set to something other than no_event, it is enqueued.
8755
8756 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
8757 mark bits. */
8758
8759 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8760
8761 static void
8762 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
8763 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8764 XEvent *event;
8765 struct input_event *emacs_event;
8766 {
8767 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
8768 abort ();
8769
8770 emacs_event->kind = scroll_bar_click;
8771 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
8772 emacs_event->modifiers
8773 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
8774 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
8775 event->xbutton.state)
8776 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
8777 ? up_modifier
8778 : down_modifier));
8779 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
8780 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
8781 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
8782 {
8783 #if 0
8784 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
8785 int internal_height
8786 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
8787 #endif
8788 int top_range
8789 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
8790 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
8791
8792 if (y < 0) y = 0;
8793 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
8794
8795 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
8796 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
8797 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
8798 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
8799 else
8800 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
8801
8802 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
8803 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
8804 whether or not we're dragging. */
8805 #if 0
8806 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
8807 holding it. */
8808 if (event->type == ButtonPress
8809 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
8810 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
8811 #endif
8812
8813 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
8814 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
8815 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
8816 {
8817 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
8818 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
8819
8820 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
8821 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8822 }
8823
8824 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
8825 #if 0
8826 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
8827 the handle. */
8828 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
8829 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
8830 else
8831 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
8832 #else
8833 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
8834 #endif
8835
8836 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
8837 }
8838 }
8839
8840 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
8841
8842 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
8843 mark bits. */
8844
8845 static void
8846 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
8847 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8848 XEvent *event;
8849 {
8850 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
8851
8852 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
8853
8854 f->mouse_moved = 1;
8855 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
8856
8857 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
8858 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
8859 {
8860 /* Where should the handle be now? */
8861 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
8862
8863 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
8864 {
8865 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
8866
8867 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
8868 }
8869 }
8870 }
8871
8872 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8873
8874 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
8875 on the scroll bar. */
8876
8877 static void
8878 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
8879 FRAME_PTR *fp;
8880 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
8881 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
8882 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
8883 unsigned long *time;
8884 {
8885 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
8886 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
8887 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
8888 int win_x, win_y;
8889 Window dummy_window;
8890 int dummy_coord;
8891 unsigned int dummy_mask;
8892
8893 BLOCK_INPUT;
8894
8895 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
8896 report that. */
8897 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
8898
8899 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
8900 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
8901 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
8902
8903 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
8904 &win_x, &win_y,
8905
8906 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
8907 &dummy_mask))
8908 ;
8909 else
8910 {
8911 #if 0
8912 int inside_height
8913 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
8914 #endif
8915 int top_range
8916 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
8917
8918 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
8919
8920 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
8921 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
8922
8923 if (win_y < 0)
8924 win_y = 0;
8925 if (win_y > top_range)
8926 win_y = top_range;
8927
8928 *fp = f;
8929 *bar_window = bar->window;
8930
8931 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
8932 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
8933 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
8934 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
8935 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
8936 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
8937 else
8938 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
8939
8940 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
8941 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
8942
8943 f->mouse_moved = 0;
8944 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
8945 }
8946
8947 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
8948
8949 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8950 }
8951
8952
8953 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
8954 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
8955 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
8956 redraw them. */
8957
8958 void
8959 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
8960 FRAME_PTR f;
8961 {
8962 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8963 Lisp_Object bar;
8964
8965 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
8966 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
8967 But in that case we should not clear them. */
8968 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8969 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
8970 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
8971 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
8972 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
8973 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8974 }
8975
8976 /* This processes Expose events from the menu-bar specific X event
8977 loop in xmenu.c. This allows to redisplay the frame if necessary
8978 when handling menu-bar or pop-up items. */
8979
8980 int
8981 process_expose_from_menu (event)
8982 XEvent event;
8983 {
8984 FRAME_PTR f;
8985 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8986 int frame_exposed_p = 0;
8987
8988 BLOCK_INPUT;
8989
8990 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (event.xexpose.display);
8991 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
8992 if (f)
8993 {
8994 if (f->async_visible == 0)
8995 {
8996 f->async_visible = 1;
8997 f->async_iconified = 0;
8998 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
8999 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9000 }
9001 else
9002 {
9003 expose_frame (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window),
9004 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
9005 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
9006 frame_exposed_p = 1;
9007 }
9008 }
9009 else
9010 {
9011 struct scroll_bar *bar
9012 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.window);
9013
9014 if (bar)
9015 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
9016 }
9017
9018 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9019 return frame_exposed_p;
9020 }
9021 \f
9022 /* Define a queue to save up SelectionRequest events for later handling. */
9023
9024 struct selection_event_queue
9025 {
9026 XEvent event;
9027 struct selection_event_queue *next;
9028 };
9029
9030 static struct selection_event_queue *queue;
9031
9032 /* Nonzero means queue up certain events--don't process them yet. */
9033
9034 static int x_queue_selection_requests;
9035
9036 /* Queue up an X event *EVENT, to be processed later. */
9037
9038 static void
9039 x_queue_event (f, event)
9040 FRAME_PTR f;
9041 XEvent *event;
9042 {
9043 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp
9044 = (struct selection_event_queue *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct selection_event_queue));
9045
9046 if (queue_tmp != NULL)
9047 {
9048 queue_tmp->event = *event;
9049 queue_tmp->next = queue;
9050 queue = queue_tmp;
9051 }
9052 }
9053
9054 /* Take all the queued events and put them back
9055 so that they get processed afresh. */
9056
9057 static void
9058 x_unqueue_events (display)
9059 Display *display;
9060 {
9061 while (queue != NULL)
9062 {
9063 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp = queue;
9064 XPutBackEvent (display, &queue_tmp->event);
9065 queue = queue_tmp->next;
9066 xfree ((char *)queue_tmp);
9067 }
9068 }
9069
9070 /* Start queuing SelectionRequest events. */
9071
9072 void
9073 x_start_queuing_selection_requests (display)
9074 Display *display;
9075 {
9076 x_queue_selection_requests++;
9077 }
9078
9079 /* Stop queuing SelectionRequest events. */
9080
9081 void
9082 x_stop_queuing_selection_requests (display)
9083 Display *display;
9084 {
9085 x_queue_selection_requests--;
9086 x_unqueue_events (display);
9087 }
9088 \f
9089 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
9090
9091 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
9092 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
9093 sometimes don't work. */
9094
9095 static Time enter_timestamp;
9096
9097 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
9098 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
9099 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
9100 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
9101
9102 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
9103 given for enter_time stamp, above. */
9104
9105 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
9106
9107 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
9108 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
9109
9110 static int temp_index;
9111 static short temp_buffer[100];
9112
9113 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
9114 on a particular display. */
9115
9116 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
9117
9118 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
9119 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
9120 We try all the open displays, one by one.
9121 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
9122
9123 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
9124
9125 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
9126 do \
9127 { \
9128 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
9129 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
9130 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
9131 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
9132 if (numchars >= 1) \
9133 { \
9134 bufp->kind = menu_bar_activate_event; \
9135 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f); \
9136 bufp->arg = Qnil; \
9137 bufp++; \
9138 count++; \
9139 numchars--; \
9140 } \
9141 } \
9142 while (0)
9143
9144 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
9145 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
9146
9147 /* Read events coming from the X server.
9148 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
9149 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
9150
9151 Events representing keys are stored in buffer BUFP,
9152 which can hold up to NUMCHARS characters.
9153 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
9154 thus pretending to be `read'.
9155
9156 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
9157
9158 int
9159 XTread_socket (sd, bufp, numchars, expected)
9160 register int sd;
9161 /* register */ struct input_event *bufp;
9162 /* register */ int numchars;
9163 int expected;
9164 {
9165 int count = 0;
9166 int nbytes = 0;
9167 XEvent event;
9168 struct frame *f;
9169 int event_found = 0;
9170 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9171 struct coding_system coding;
9172
9173 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
9174 {
9175 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
9176 return -1;
9177 }
9178
9179 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
9180 BLOCK_INPUT;
9181
9182 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
9183 input_signal_count++;
9184
9185 if (numchars <= 0)
9186 abort (); /* Don't think this happens. */
9187
9188 ++handling_signal;
9189
9190 /* The input should be decoded if it is from XIM. Currently the
9191 locale of XIM is the same as that of the system. So, we can use
9192 Vlocale_coding_system which is initialized properly at Emacs
9193 startup time. */
9194 setup_coding_system (Vlocale_coding_system, &coding);
9195 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
9196 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
9197 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't handle
9198 composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that gives us composition
9199 information. */
9200 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
9201
9202 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
9203 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
9204 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
9205 {
9206 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
9207 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
9208 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
9209 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
9210 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
9211 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
9212 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
9213 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
9214 #endif
9215
9216 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
9217 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
9218 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
9219 for X connections. */
9220 #ifndef SIGIO
9221 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
9222 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
9223 {
9224 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
9225 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
9226 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
9227 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
9228 }
9229 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
9230 #endif /* SIGIO */
9231 #endif
9232
9233 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
9234 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
9235 {
9236 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
9237 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
9238 }
9239
9240 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
9241 {
9242 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
9243
9244 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9245 {
9246 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
9247 XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
9248 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
9249 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
9250 was created. */
9251 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
9252 event.xclient.window);
9253 if (XFilterEvent (&event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None))
9254 break;
9255 }
9256 #endif
9257 event_found = 1;
9258
9259 switch (event.type)
9260 {
9261 case ClientMessage:
9262 {
9263 if (event.xclient.message_type
9264 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
9265 && event.xclient.format == 32)
9266 {
9267 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
9268 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
9269 {
9270 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
9271 could be the shell widget window
9272 if the frame has no title bar. */
9273 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
9274 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9275 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
9276 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
9277 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
9278 #endif
9279 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
9280 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
9281 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
9282 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
9283 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
9284 needed.
9285
9286 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
9287 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
9288 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
9289 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
9290 Emacs. */
9291
9292 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
9293 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
9294 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
9295 if (f)
9296 {
9297 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
9298 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
9299 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
9300 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
9301 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
9302 /* The ICCCM says this is
9303 the only valid choice. */
9304 RevertToParent,
9305 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
9306 /* This is needed to detect the error
9307 if there is an error. */
9308 XSync (d, False);
9309 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
9310 }
9311 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
9312 #endif /* 0 */
9313 }
9314 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
9315 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
9316 {
9317 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
9318 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
9319 the session manager, who's looking for such a
9320 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
9321 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
9322 if (numchars > 0)
9323 {
9324 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
9325 event.xclient.window);
9326
9327 /* This is just so we only give real data once
9328 for a single Emacs process. */
9329 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
9330 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9331 event.xclient.window,
9332 initial_argv, initial_argc);
9333 else if (f)
9334 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9335 event.xclient.window,
9336 0, 0);
9337 }
9338 }
9339 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
9340 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
9341 {
9342 struct frame *f
9343 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
9344 event.xclient.window);
9345
9346 if (f)
9347 {
9348 if (numchars == 0)
9349 abort ();
9350
9351 bufp->kind = delete_window_event;
9352 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
9353 bufp->arg = Qnil;
9354 bufp++;
9355
9356 count += 1;
9357 numchars -= 1;
9358 }
9359 }
9360 }
9361 else if (event.xclient.message_type
9362 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
9363 {
9364 }
9365 else if (event.xclient.message_type
9366 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
9367 {
9368 int new_x, new_y;
9369 struct frame *f
9370 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
9371
9372 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
9373 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
9374
9375 if (f)
9376 {
9377 f->output_data.x->left_pos = new_x;
9378 f->output_data.x->top_pos = new_y;
9379 }
9380 }
9381 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
9382 else if (event.xclient.message_type
9383 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
9384 {
9385 struct frame *f
9386 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
9387 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
9388 &event, NULL);
9389 }
9390 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
9391 else if ((event.xclient.message_type
9392 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
9393 || (event.xclient.message_type
9394 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
9395 {
9396 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
9397 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
9398 currently never do because we are interested in
9399 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
9400 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
9401 struct frame *f
9402 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
9403 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
9404 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
9405 }
9406 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9407 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
9408 we construct an input_event. */
9409 else if (event.xclient.message_type
9410 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
9411 {
9412 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, bufp);
9413 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
9414 goto out;
9415 }
9416 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9417 else
9418 goto OTHER;
9419 }
9420 break;
9421
9422 case SelectionNotify:
9423 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9424 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
9425 goto OTHER;
9426 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9427 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
9428 break;
9429
9430 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
9431 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9432 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
9433 goto OTHER;
9434 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9435 {
9436 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
9437
9438 if (numchars == 0)
9439 abort ();
9440
9441 bufp->kind = selection_clear_event;
9442 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
9443 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
9444 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
9445 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
9446 bufp->arg = Qnil;
9447 bufp++;
9448
9449 count += 1;
9450 numchars -= 1;
9451 }
9452 break;
9453
9454 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
9455 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9456 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
9457 goto OTHER;
9458 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9459 if (x_queue_selection_requests)
9460 x_queue_event (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner),
9461 &event);
9462 else
9463 {
9464 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
9465
9466 if (numchars == 0)
9467 abort ();
9468
9469 bufp->kind = selection_request_event;
9470 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
9471 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (bufp) = eventp->requestor;
9472 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
9473 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (bufp) = eventp->target;
9474 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (bufp) = eventp->property;
9475 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
9476 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
9477 bufp->arg = Qnil;
9478 bufp++;
9479
9480 count += 1;
9481 numchars -= 1;
9482 }
9483 break;
9484
9485 case PropertyNotify:
9486 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9487 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
9488 goto OTHER;
9489 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9490 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
9491 break;
9492
9493 case ReparentNotify:
9494 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
9495 if (f)
9496 {
9497 int x, y;
9498 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
9499 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
9500 f->output_data.x->left_pos = x;
9501 f->output_data.x->top_pos = y;
9502 }
9503 break;
9504
9505 case Expose:
9506 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
9507 if (f)
9508 {
9509 if (f->async_visible == 0)
9510 {
9511 f->async_visible = 1;
9512 f->async_iconified = 0;
9513 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
9514 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9515 }
9516 else
9517 expose_frame (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
9518 event.xexpose.window),
9519 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
9520 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
9521 }
9522 else
9523 {
9524 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9525 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
9526 goto OTHER;
9527 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9528 struct scroll_bar *bar
9529 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.window);
9530
9531 if (bar)
9532 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
9533 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9534 else
9535 goto OTHER;
9536 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9537 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9538 }
9539 break;
9540
9541 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
9542 source area was obscured or not
9543 available.*/
9544 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
9545 if (f)
9546 {
9547 expose_frame (f,
9548 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
9549 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
9550 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
9551 }
9552 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9553 else
9554 goto OTHER;
9555 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9556 break;
9557
9558 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
9559 source area was completely
9560 available */
9561 break;
9562
9563 case UnmapNotify:
9564 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
9565 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
9566 {
9567 tip_window = 0;
9568 redo_mouse_highlight ();
9569 }
9570
9571 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
9572 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
9573 the frame was deleted. */
9574 {
9575 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
9576 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
9577 display that won't ever be seen. */
9578 f->async_visible = 0;
9579 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
9580 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
9581 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
9582 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
9583 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
9584 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
9585 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9586 {
9587 f->async_iconified = 1;
9588
9589 bufp->kind = iconify_event;
9590 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
9591 bufp->arg = Qnil;
9592 bufp++;
9593 count++;
9594 numchars--;
9595 }
9596 }
9597 goto OTHER;
9598
9599 case MapNotify:
9600 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
9601 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
9602 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
9603 goto OTHER;
9604
9605 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
9606 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
9607 frame is visible. */
9608 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
9609 if (f)
9610 {
9611 f->async_visible = 1;
9612 f->async_iconified = 0;
9613 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
9614
9615 /* wait_reading_process_input will notice this and update
9616 the frame's display structures. */
9617 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9618
9619 if (f->iconified)
9620 {
9621 bufp->kind = deiconify_event;
9622 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
9623 bufp->arg = Qnil;
9624 bufp++;
9625 count++;
9626 numchars--;
9627 }
9628 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
9629 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
9630 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
9631 to update the frame titles
9632 in case this is the second frame. */
9633 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
9634 }
9635 goto OTHER;
9636
9637 case KeyPress:
9638 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
9639
9640 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
9641 /* I couldn't find a way to prevent LessTif scroll bars
9642 from consuming key events. */
9643 if (f == 0)
9644 {
9645 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
9646 event.xkey.window);
9647 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
9648 {
9649 widget = XtParent (widget);
9650 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
9651 }
9652 }
9653 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
9654
9655 if (f != 0)
9656 {
9657 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
9658 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
9659 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
9660 his Emacs hang.
9661
9662 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
9663 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
9664 status_return even if the input is too long to
9665 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
9666 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
9667 two-byte character set) seems to be a faily good
9668 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
9669 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
9670 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
9671 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
9672 int modifiers;
9673
9674 event.xkey.state
9675 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
9676 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
9677 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
9678
9679 /* This will have to go some day... */
9680
9681 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
9682 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
9683 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
9684 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
9685 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
9686 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
9687 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
9688
9689 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
9690 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
9691 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
9692 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
9693 not it is combined with Meta. */
9694 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
9695 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
9696
9697 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9698 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9699 {
9700 Status status_return;
9701
9702 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
9703 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
9704 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
9705 &status_return);
9706 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
9707 {
9708 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
9709 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
9710 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
9711 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
9712 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
9713 &status_return);
9714 }
9715
9716 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
9717 break;
9718 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
9719 {
9720 keysym = NoSymbol;
9721 modifiers = 0;
9722 }
9723 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
9724 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
9725 abort ();
9726 }
9727 else
9728 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
9729 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
9730 &compose_status);
9731 #else
9732 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
9733 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
9734 &compose_status);
9735 #endif
9736
9737 orig_keysym = keysym;
9738
9739 if (numchars > 1)
9740 {
9741 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
9742 || keysym == XK_Delete
9743 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
9744 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
9745 #endif
9746 || (keysym >= XK_Kanji && keysym <= XK_Eisu_toggle)
9747 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
9748 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
9749 #ifdef HPUX
9750 /* This recognizes the "extended function keys".
9751 It seems there's no cleaner way.
9752 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling mode_switch
9753 incorrectly. */
9754 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
9755 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
9756 #endif
9757 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
9758 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
9759 #endif
9760 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
9761 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
9762 #endif
9763 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
9764 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
9765 #endif
9766 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
9767 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
9768 #endif
9769 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
9770 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
9771 #endif
9772 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
9773 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
9774 #endif
9775 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
9776 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
9777 #endif
9778 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
9779 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
9780 #endif
9781 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
9782 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
9783 #endif
9784 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
9785 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
9786 #endif
9787 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
9788 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
9789 #endif
9790 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
9791 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
9792 #endif
9793 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
9794 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
9795 #endif
9796 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
9797 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
9798 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
9799 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28)))
9800 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
9801 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
9802 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
9803 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
9804 #endif
9805 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
9806 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
9807 #endif
9808 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
9809 ))
9810 {
9811 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short))
9812 temp_index = 0;
9813 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = keysym;
9814 bufp->kind = non_ascii_keystroke;
9815 bufp->code = keysym;
9816 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
9817 bufp->arg = Qnil;
9818 bufp->modifiers
9819 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
9820 modifiers);
9821 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
9822 bufp++;
9823 count++;
9824 numchars--;
9825 }
9826 else if (numchars > nbytes)
9827 {
9828 register int i;
9829 register int c;
9830 unsigned char *p, *pend;
9831 int nchars, len;
9832
9833 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
9834 {
9835 if (temp_index == (sizeof temp_buffer
9836 / sizeof (short)))
9837 temp_index = 0;
9838 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = copy_bufptr[i];
9839 }
9840
9841 if (/* If the event is not from XIM, */
9842 event.xkey.keycode != 0
9843 /* or the current locale doesn't request
9844 decoding of the intup data, ... */
9845 || coding.type == coding_type_raw_text
9846 || coding.type == coding_type_no_conversion)
9847 {
9848 /* ... we can use the input data as is. */
9849 nchars = nbytes;
9850 }
9851 else
9852 {
9853 /* We have to decode the input data. */
9854 int require;
9855 unsigned char *p;
9856
9857 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
9858 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
9859 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
9860 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p,
9861 nbytes, require);
9862 nbytes = coding.produced;
9863 nchars = coding.produced_char;
9864 copy_bufptr = p;
9865 }
9866
9867 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
9868 character events. */
9869 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
9870 {
9871 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
9872 nbytes - i, len);
9873 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
9874 ? ascii_keystroke
9875 : multibyte_char_keystroke);
9876 bufp->code = c;
9877 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
9878 bufp->arg = Qnil;
9879 bufp->modifiers
9880 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
9881 modifiers);
9882 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
9883 bufp++;
9884 }
9885
9886 count += nchars;
9887 numchars -= nchars;
9888
9889 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
9890 break;
9891 }
9892 else
9893 abort ();
9894 }
9895 else
9896 abort ();
9897 }
9898 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9899 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
9900 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
9901 client. */
9902 break;
9903 #else
9904 goto OTHER;
9905 #endif
9906
9907 case KeyRelease:
9908 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9909 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
9910 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
9911 client. */
9912 break;
9913 #else
9914 goto OTHER;
9915 #endif
9916
9917 /* Here's a possible interpretation of the whole
9918 FocusIn-EnterNotify FocusOut-LeaveNotify mess. If
9919 you get a FocusIn event, you have to get a FocusOut
9920 event before you relinquish the focus. If you
9921 haven't received a FocusIn event, then a mere
9922 LeaveNotify is enough to free you. */
9923
9924 case EnterNotify:
9925 {
9926 int from_menu_bar_p = 0;
9927
9928 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
9929
9930 #ifdef LESSTIF_VERSION
9931 /* When clicking outside of a menu bar popup to close
9932 it, we get a FocusIn/ EnterNotify sequence of
9933 events. The flag event.xcrossing.focus is not set
9934 in the EnterNotify event of that sequence because
9935 the focus is in the menu bar,
9936 event.xcrossing.window is the frame's X window.
9937 Unconditionally setting the focus frame to null in
9938 this case is not the right thing, because no event
9939 follows that could set the focus frame to the right
9940 value.
9941
9942 This could be a LessTif bug, but I wasn't able to
9943 reproduce the behavior in a simple test program.
9944
9945 (gerd, LessTif 0.88.1). */
9946
9947 if (!event.xcrossing.focus
9948 && f
9949 && f->output_data.x->menubar_widget)
9950 {
9951 Window focus;
9952 int revert;
9953
9954 XGetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), &focus, &revert);
9955 if (focus == XtWindow (f->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
9956 from_menu_bar_p = 1;
9957 }
9958 #endif /* LESSTIF_VERSION */
9959
9960 if (event.xcrossing.focus || from_menu_bar_p)
9961 {
9962 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
9963 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
9964 || !(f->auto_lower)
9965 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
9966 {
9967 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
9968 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
9969 }
9970 }
9971 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9972 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
9973
9974 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
9975 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
9976 if (f && !f->output_data.x->busy_p)
9977 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
9978 goto OTHER;
9979 }
9980
9981 case FocusIn:
9982 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xfocus.window);
9983 if (event.xfocus.detail != NotifyPointer)
9984 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = f;
9985 if (f)
9986 {
9987 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
9988
9989 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
9990 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
9991 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
9992 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
9993 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
9994 {
9995 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
9996 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
9997 bufp->arg = Qnil;
9998 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
9999 }
10000 }
10001
10002 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10003 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
10004 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
10005 #endif
10006
10007 goto OTHER;
10008
10009 case LeaveNotify:
10010 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
10011 if (f)
10012 {
10013 Lisp_Object frame;
10014 int from_menu_bar_p = 0;
10015
10016 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
10017 {
10018 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
10019 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
10020 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10021 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10022 }
10023
10024 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
10025 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
10026 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
10027 the mouse leaves the frame. */
10028 if (any_help_event_p)
10029 {
10030 Lisp_Object frame;
10031 int n;
10032
10033 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
10034 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars,
10035 Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
10036 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
10037 }
10038
10039 #ifdef LESSTIF_VERSION
10040 /* Please see the comment at the start of the
10041 EnterNotify case. */
10042 if (!event.xcrossing.focus
10043 && f->output_data.x->menubar_widget)
10044 {
10045 Window focus;
10046 int revert;
10047 XGetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), &focus, &revert);
10048 if (focus == XtWindow (f->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
10049 from_menu_bar_p = 1;
10050 }
10051 #endif /* LESSTIF_VERSION */
10052
10053 if (event.xcrossing.focus || from_menu_bar_p)
10054 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo);
10055 else
10056 {
10057 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
10058 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10059 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10060 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
10061 }
10062 }
10063 goto OTHER;
10064
10065 case FocusOut:
10066 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xfocus.window);
10067 if (event.xfocus.detail != NotifyPointer
10068 && f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
10069 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10070 if (f && f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10071 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
10072
10073 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10074 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
10075 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
10076 #endif
10077
10078 goto OTHER;
10079
10080 case MotionNotify:
10081 {
10082 previous_help_echo = help_echo;
10083 help_echo = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
10084 help_echo_pos = -1;
10085
10086 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
10087 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
10088 f = last_mouse_frame;
10089 else
10090 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
10091
10092 if (f)
10093 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
10094 else
10095 {
10096 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10097 struct scroll_bar *bar
10098 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.window);
10099
10100 if (bar)
10101 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
10102 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10103
10104 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
10105 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
10106 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10107 }
10108
10109 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo
10110 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
10111 if (!NILP (help_echo)
10112 || !NILP (previous_help_echo))
10113 {
10114 Lisp_Object frame;
10115 int n;
10116
10117 if (f)
10118 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
10119 else
10120 frame = Qnil;
10121
10122 any_help_event_p = 1;
10123 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars, help_echo, frame,
10124 help_echo_window, help_echo_object,
10125 help_echo_pos);
10126 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
10127 }
10128
10129 goto OTHER;
10130 }
10131
10132 case ConfigureNotify:
10133 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
10134 if (f)
10135 {
10136 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10137 int rows = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, event.xconfigure.height);
10138 int columns = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, event.xconfigure.width);
10139
10140 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
10141 is called by the code that handles resizing
10142 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
10143
10144 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
10145 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
10146 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
10147 if (columns != f->width
10148 || rows != f->height
10149 || event.xconfigure.width != f->output_data.x->pixel_width
10150 || event.xconfigure.height != f->output_data.x->pixel_height)
10151 {
10152 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
10153 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
10154 cancel_mouse_face (f);
10155 }
10156 #endif
10157
10158 f->output_data.x->pixel_width = event.xconfigure.width;
10159 f->output_data.x->pixel_height = event.xconfigure.height;
10160
10161 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
10162 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
10163 x_real_positions (f, &f->output_data.x->left_pos,
10164 &f->output_data.x->top_pos);
10165
10166 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10167 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
10168 xic_set_statusarea (f);
10169 #endif
10170
10171 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
10172 {
10173 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
10174 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
10175 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
10176 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
10177 }
10178 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10179 /* Some window managers pass (0,0) as the location of
10180 the window, and the Motif event handler stores it
10181 in the emacs widget, which messes up Motif menus. */
10182 if (event.xconfigure.x == 0 && event.xconfigure.y == 0)
10183 {
10184 event.xconfigure.x = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
10185 event.xconfigure.y = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
10186 }
10187 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
10188 }
10189 goto OTHER;
10190
10191 case ButtonPress:
10192 case ButtonRelease:
10193 {
10194 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
10195 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
10196 struct input_event emacs_event;
10197 int tool_bar_p = 0;
10198
10199 emacs_event.kind = no_event;
10200 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
10201
10202 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
10203 && last_mouse_frame
10204 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
10205 f = last_mouse_frame;
10206 else
10207 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
10208
10209 if (f)
10210 {
10211 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
10212 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
10213 && XFASTINT (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->height))
10214 {
10215 Lisp_Object window;
10216 int p, x, y;
10217
10218 x = event.xbutton.x;
10219 y = event.xbutton.y;
10220
10221 /* Set x and y. */
10222 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &p, 1);
10223 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
10224 {
10225 x_handle_tool_bar_click (f, &event.xbutton);
10226 tool_bar_p = 1;
10227 }
10228 }
10229
10230 if (!tool_bar_p)
10231 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
10232 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10233 construct_mouse_click (&emacs_event, &event, f);
10234 }
10235 else
10236 {
10237 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10238 struct scroll_bar *bar
10239 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.window);
10240
10241 if (bar)
10242 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &emacs_event);
10243 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10244 }
10245
10246 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
10247 {
10248 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
10249 last_mouse_frame = f;
10250 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
10251 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
10252 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
10253 the ButtonPress. */
10254 if (f != 0)
10255 f->mouse_moved = 0;
10256
10257 if (!tool_bar_p)
10258 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10259 }
10260 else
10261 {
10262 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
10263 }
10264
10265 if (numchars >= 1 && emacs_event.kind != no_event)
10266 {
10267 bcopy (&emacs_event, bufp, sizeof (struct input_event));
10268 bufp++;
10269 count++;
10270 numchars--;
10271 }
10272
10273 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10274 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
10275 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
10276 don't pass it to Xt right now.
10277 Instead, save it away
10278 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
10279 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
10280 if (f && event.type == ButtonPress
10281 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
10282 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
10283 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
10284 && event.xbutton.x < f->output_data.x->pixel_width
10285 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
10286 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
10287 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
10288 {
10289 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
10290 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
10291 }
10292 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
10293 {
10294 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10295 goto OTHER;
10296 }
10297
10298 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
10299 but I am trying to be cautious. */
10300 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
10301 {
10302 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
10303 {
10304 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
10305 if (f->output_data.x)
10306 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
10307 }
10308 else
10309 goto OTHER;
10310 }
10311 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
10312 else
10313 goto OTHER;
10314 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10315 }
10316 break;
10317
10318 case CirculateNotify:
10319 goto OTHER;
10320
10321 case CirculateRequest:
10322 goto OTHER;
10323
10324 case VisibilityNotify:
10325 goto OTHER;
10326
10327 case MappingNotify:
10328 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
10329 local cache. */
10330 switch (event.xmapping.request)
10331 {
10332 case MappingModifier:
10333 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10334 /* This is meant to fall through. */
10335 case MappingKeyboard:
10336 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
10337 }
10338 goto OTHER;
10339
10340 default:
10341 OTHER:
10342 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10343 BLOCK_INPUT;
10344 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
10345 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10346 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10347 break;
10348 }
10349 }
10350 }
10351
10352 out:;
10353
10354 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
10355 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
10356 if (! event_found)
10357 {
10358 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
10359 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
10360 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
10361 x_noop_count++;
10362 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
10363 {
10364 x_noop_count=0;
10365
10366 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
10367 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
10368
10369 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
10370
10371 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
10372 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
10373 }
10374 }
10375
10376 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
10377 raise it now. */
10378 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
10379 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
10380 {
10381 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
10382 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10383 }
10384
10385 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10386 --handling_signal;
10387 return count;
10388 }
10389
10390
10391
10392 \f
10393 /***********************************************************************
10394 Text Cursor
10395 ***********************************************************************/
10396
10397 /* Note if the text cursor of window W has been overwritten by a
10398 drawing operation that outputs N glyphs starting at HPOS in the
10399 line given by output_cursor.vpos. N < 0 means all the rest of the
10400 line after HPOS has been written. */
10401
10402 static void
10403 note_overwritten_text_cursor (w, hpos, n)
10404 struct window *w;
10405 int hpos, n;
10406 {
10407 if (updated_area == TEXT_AREA
10408 && output_cursor.vpos == w->phys_cursor.vpos
10409 && hpos <= w->phys_cursor.hpos
10410 && (n < 0
10411 || hpos + n > w->phys_cursor.hpos))
10412 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
10413 }
10414
10415
10416 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
10417 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
10418 WHOLE_LINE_P non-zero means include the areas used for truncation
10419 mark display and alike in the clipping rectangle.
10420
10421 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
10422 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
10423 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
10424
10425 static void
10426 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, whole_line_p)
10427 struct window *w;
10428 struct glyph_row *row;
10429 GC gc;
10430 int whole_line_p;
10431 {
10432 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
10433 XRectangle clip_rect;
10434 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
10435
10436 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
10437
10438 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
10439 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
10440 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
10441 clip_rect.width = window_width;
10442 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
10443
10444 /* If clipping to the whole line, including trunc marks, extend
10445 the rectangle to the left and increase its width. */
10446 if (whole_line_p)
10447 {
10448 clip_rect.x -= FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
10449 clip_rect.width += FRAME_X_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
10450 }
10451
10452 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
10453 }
10454
10455
10456 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
10457
10458 static void
10459 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
10460 struct window *w;
10461 struct glyph_row *row;
10462 {
10463 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
10464 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10465 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
10466 int x, y, wd, h;
10467 XGCValues xgcv;
10468 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
10469 GC gc;
10470
10471 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
10472 coordinates. */
10473 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
10474 y = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y)
10475 + row->ascent - w->phys_cursor_ascent);
10476 h = row->height - 1;
10477
10478 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
10479 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
10480 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
10481 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
10482 return;
10483
10484 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
10485 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
10486 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
10487 width instead. */
10488 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
10489 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
10490 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
10491 wd = min (CANON_X_UNIT (f), wd);
10492
10493 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
10494 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
10495 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
10496 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
10497 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
10498 else
10499 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
10500 GCForeground, &xgcv);
10501 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
10502
10503 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
10504 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 0);
10505 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
10506 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
10507 }
10508
10509
10510 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
10511
10512 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
10513 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
10514 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
10515 --gerd. */
10516
10517 static void
10518 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width)
10519 struct window *w;
10520 struct glyph_row *row;
10521 int width;
10522 {
10523 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
10524 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
10525 GC gc;
10526 int x;
10527 unsigned long mask;
10528 XGCValues xgcv;
10529 Display *dpy;
10530 Window window;
10531
10532 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
10533 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
10534 and mini-buffer. */
10535 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
10536 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
10537 return;
10538
10539 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
10540 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
10541 the bar might not be in the window. */
10542 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
10543 {
10544 struct glyph_row *row;
10545 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
10546 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
10547 }
10548 else
10549 {
10550 xgcv.background = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
10551 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
10552 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
10553 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
10554 dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
10555 window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
10556 gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
10557
10558 if (gc)
10559 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
10560 else
10561 {
10562 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
10563 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
10564 }
10565
10566 if (width < 0)
10567 width = f->output_data.x->cursor_width;
10568
10569 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
10570 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 0);
10571 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
10572 x,
10573 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
10574 min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width),
10575 row->height);
10576 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
10577 }
10578 }
10579
10580
10581 /* Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
10582 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
10583 is is about to be rewritten. */
10584
10585 static void
10586 x_clear_cursor (w)
10587 struct window *w;
10588 {
10589 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
10590 x_update_window_cursor (w, 0);
10591 }
10592
10593
10594 /* Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
10595 comment of x_draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
10596
10597 static void
10598 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, hl)
10599 struct window *w;
10600 struct glyph_row *row;
10601 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
10602 {
10603 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
10604 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
10605 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
10606 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])
10607 {
10608 x_draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA,
10609 w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.hpos + 1,
10610 hl, 0, 0, 0);
10611
10612 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
10613 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
10614 are redrawn. */
10615 if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
10616 {
10617 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
10618 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
10619 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA);
10620
10621 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
10622 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
10623 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA);
10624 }
10625 }
10626 }
10627
10628
10629 /* Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
10630
10631 static void
10632 x_erase_phys_cursor (w)
10633 struct window *w;
10634 {
10635 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
10636 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10637 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
10638 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
10639 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
10640 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
10641 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
10642 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
10643 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
10644
10645 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
10646 screen. */
10647 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
10648 goto mark_cursor_off;
10649
10650 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
10651 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
10652 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
10653 goto mark_cursor_off;
10654
10655 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
10656 can do. */
10657 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
10658 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
10659 goto mark_cursor_off;
10660
10661 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
10662 In this case, either x_draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
10663 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
10664 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
10665 cursor glyph at hand. */
10666 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
10667 goto mark_cursor_off;
10668
10669 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
10670 we clear the cursor. */
10671 if (! NILP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
10672 && w == XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
10673 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
10674 || (vpos == dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
10675 && hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
10676 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
10677 || (vpos == dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
10678 && hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
10679 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
10680 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
10681 mouse highlighting does not. */
10682 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos)
10683 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
10684
10685 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
10686 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
10687 {
10688 int x;
10689 int header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
10690
10691 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
10692 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
10693 goto mark_cursor_off;
10694
10695 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
10696
10697 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
10698 x,
10699 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
10700 cursor_row->y)),
10701 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
10702 cursor_row->visible_height,
10703 False);
10704 }
10705
10706 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
10707 if (mouse_face_here_p)
10708 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
10709 else if (cursor_row->inverse_p)
10710 hl = DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO;
10711 else
10712 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
10713 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
10714
10715 mark_cursor_off:
10716 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
10717 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
10718 }
10719
10720
10721 /* Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
10722 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
10723 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
10724
10725 void
10726 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y)
10727 struct window *w;
10728 int on, hpos, vpos, x, y;
10729 {
10730 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
10731 int new_cursor_type;
10732 int new_cursor_width;
10733 struct glyph_matrix *current_glyphs;
10734 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
10735 struct glyph *glyph;
10736
10737 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
10738 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
10739 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
10740 window. */
10741 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
10742 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
10743 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
10744 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
10745 return;
10746
10747 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
10748 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
10749 return;
10750
10751 current_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
10752 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_glyphs, vpos);
10753 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
10754
10755 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
10756 display the cursor. */
10757 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
10758 {
10759 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
10760 return;
10761 }
10762
10763 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
10764
10765 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. In a
10766 mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we are
10767 reading input from this window. For the selected window, we want
10768 the cursor type given by the frame parameter. If explicitly
10769 marked off, draw no cursor. In all other cases, we want a hollow
10770 box cursor. */
10771 new_cursor_width = -1;
10772 if (cursor_in_echo_area
10773 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
10774 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
10775 {
10776 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
10777 new_cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
10778 else
10779 new_cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
10780 }
10781 else
10782 {
10783 if (w != XWINDOW (selected_window)
10784 || f != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame)
10785 {
10786 extern int cursor_in_non_selected_windows;
10787
10788 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
10789 || !cursor_in_non_selected_windows
10790 || NILP (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->cursor_type))
10791 new_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
10792 else
10793 new_cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
10794 }
10795 else if (w->cursor_off_p)
10796 new_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
10797 else
10798 {
10799 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
10800
10801 if (EQ (b->cursor_type, Qt))
10802 new_cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
10803 else
10804 new_cursor_type = x_specified_cursor_type (b->cursor_type,
10805 &new_cursor_width);
10806 }
10807 }
10808
10809 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
10810 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
10811 erase it. */
10812 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
10813 && (!on
10814 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
10815 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
10816 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type))
10817 x_erase_phys_cursor (w);
10818
10819 /* If the cursor is now invisible and we want it to be visible,
10820 display it. */
10821 if (on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
10822 {
10823 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
10824 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
10825
10826 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
10827 of them may need the information. */
10828 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
10829 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
10830 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
10831 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
10832 w->phys_cursor_type = new_cursor_type;
10833 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
10834
10835 switch (new_cursor_type)
10836 {
10837 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
10838 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
10839 break;
10840
10841 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
10842 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
10843 break;
10844
10845 case BAR_CURSOR:
10846 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, new_cursor_width);
10847 break;
10848
10849 case NO_CURSOR:
10850 break;
10851
10852 default:
10853 abort ();
10854 }
10855
10856 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10857 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
10858 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
10859 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
10860 #endif
10861 }
10862
10863 #ifndef XFlush
10864 if (updating_frame != f)
10865 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10866 #endif
10867 }
10868
10869
10870 /* Display the cursor on window W, or clear it. X and Y are window
10871 relative pixel coordinates. HPOS and VPOS are glyph matrix
10872 positions. If W is not the selected window, display a hollow
10873 cursor. ON non-zero means display the cursor at X, Y which
10874 correspond to HPOS, VPOS, otherwise it is cleared. */
10875
10876 void
10877 x_display_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y)
10878 struct window *w;
10879 int on, hpos, vpos, x, y;
10880 {
10881 BLOCK_INPUT;
10882 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y);
10883 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10884 }
10885
10886
10887 /* Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
10888 Don't change the cursor's position. */
10889
10890 void
10891 x_update_cursor (f, on_p)
10892 struct frame *f;
10893 {
10894 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
10895 }
10896
10897
10898 /* Call x_update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
10899 in the window tree rooted at W. */
10900
10901 static void
10902 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (w, on_p)
10903 struct window *w;
10904 int on_p;
10905 {
10906 while (w)
10907 {
10908 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
10909 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
10910 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
10911 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
10912 else
10913 x_update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
10914
10915 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
10916 }
10917 }
10918
10919
10920 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
10921 of ON. */
10922
10923 static void
10924 x_update_window_cursor (w, on)
10925 struct window *w;
10926 int on;
10927 {
10928 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
10929 of being deleted. */
10930 if (w->current_matrix)
10931 {
10932 BLOCK_INPUT;
10933 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
10934 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
10935 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10936 }
10937 }
10938
10939
10940
10941 \f
10942 /* Icons. */
10943
10944 /* Refresh bitmap kitchen sink icon for frame F
10945 when we get an expose event for it. */
10946
10947 void
10948 refreshicon (f)
10949 struct frame *f;
10950 {
10951 /* Normally, the window manager handles this function. */
10952 }
10953
10954 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
10955
10956 int
10957 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
10958 struct frame *f;
10959 Lisp_Object file;
10960 {
10961 int bitmap_id;
10962
10963 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
10964 return 1;
10965
10966 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap if any. */
10967 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
10968 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
10969 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
10970
10971 if (STRINGP (file))
10972 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
10973 else
10974 {
10975 /* Create the GNU bitmap if necessary. */
10976 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
10977 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
10978 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
10979 gnu_width, gnu_height);
10980
10981 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap,
10982 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
10983 As a result, the GNU bitmap is never freed.
10984 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
10985 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
10986
10987 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
10988 }
10989
10990 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
10991 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
10992
10993 return 0;
10994 }
10995
10996
10997 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
10998 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
10999
11000 int
11001 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
11002 struct frame *f;
11003 char *icon_name;
11004 {
11005 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
11006 return 1;
11007
11008 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
11009 {
11010 XTextProperty text;
11011 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
11012 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
11013 text.format = 8;
11014 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
11015 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11016 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
11017 &text);
11018 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11019 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), &text);
11020 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11021 }
11022 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
11023 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
11024 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
11025
11026 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
11027 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
11028 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
11029 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
11030
11031 return 0;
11032 }
11033 \f
11034 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
11035
11036 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
11037 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
11038
11039 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
11040
11041 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
11042 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
11043 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
11044
11045 static void
11046 x_error_catcher (display, error)
11047 Display *display;
11048 XErrorEvent *error;
11049 {
11050 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
11051 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data,
11052 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
11053 }
11054
11055 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
11056 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
11057 operating on.
11058
11059 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
11060 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
11061 stored in x_error_message_string.
11062
11063 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
11064 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
11065
11066 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
11067
11068 void x_check_errors ();
11069 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
11070
11071 int
11072 x_catch_errors (dpy)
11073 Display *dpy;
11074 {
11075 int count = specpdl_ptr - specpdl;
11076
11077 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
11078 XSync (dpy, False);
11079
11080 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind, x_error_message_string);
11081
11082 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
11083 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] = 0;
11084
11085 return count;
11086 }
11087
11088 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
11089
11090 static Lisp_Object
11091 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
11092 Lisp_Object old_val;
11093 {
11094 x_error_message_string = old_val;
11095 return Qnil;
11096 }
11097
11098 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
11099 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
11100 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
11101
11102 void
11103 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
11104 Display *dpy;
11105 char *format;
11106 {
11107 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
11108 XSync (dpy, False);
11109
11110 if (XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0])
11111 error (format, XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data);
11112 }
11113
11114 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
11115 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
11116
11117 int
11118 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
11119 Display *dpy;
11120 {
11121 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
11122 XSync (dpy, False);
11123
11124 return XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] != 0;
11125 }
11126
11127 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
11128
11129 void
11130 x_clear_errors (dpy)
11131 Display *dpy;
11132 {
11133 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] = 0;
11134 }
11135
11136 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
11137 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
11138 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
11139 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
11140
11141 void
11142 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
11143 Display *dpy;
11144 int count;
11145 {
11146 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11147 }
11148
11149 #if 0
11150 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
11151 x_trace_wire ()
11152 {
11153 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
11154 }
11155 #endif /* ! 0 */
11156
11157 \f
11158 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
11159 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
11160 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
11161 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
11162 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
11163
11164 static SIGTYPE
11165 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
11166 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
11167 {
11168 #ifdef USG
11169 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
11170 must reestablish each time */
11171 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
11172 #endif /* USG */
11173 }
11174 \f
11175 /* Handling X errors. */
11176
11177 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DISPLAY. */
11178
11179 static SIGTYPE
11180 x_connection_closed (display, error_message)
11181 Display *display;
11182 char *error_message;
11183 {
11184 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
11185 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
11186
11187 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
11188
11189 #if 0 /* Closing the display caused a bus error on OpenWindows. */
11190 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11191 XtCloseDisplay (display);
11192 #endif
11193 #endif
11194
11195 if (dpyinfo)
11196 dpyinfo->display = 0;
11197
11198 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
11199 that are on the dead display. */
11200 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11201 {
11202 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
11203 minibuf_frame
11204 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
11205 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
11206 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
11207 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
11208 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
11209 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
11210 }
11211
11212 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
11213 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
11214 for another frame that we need to delete. */
11215 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11216 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
11217 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
11218 {
11219 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
11220 trying to find a replacement. */
11221 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
11222 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
11223 }
11224
11225 if (dpyinfo)
11226 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
11227
11228 if (x_display_list == 0)
11229 {
11230 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_message);
11231 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
11232 exit (70);
11233 }
11234
11235 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
11236 #ifdef SIGIO
11237 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
11238 #endif
11239 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
11240 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11241
11242 clear_waiting_for_input ();
11243 handling_signal = 0;
11244 error ("%s", error_message);
11245 }
11246
11247 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
11248 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
11249 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
11250
11251 static void
11252 x_error_quitter (display, error)
11253 Display *display;
11254 XErrorEvent *error;
11255 {
11256 char buf[256], buf1[356];
11257
11258 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11259 original error handler. */
11260
11261 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
11262 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
11263 buf, error->request_code);
11264 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
11265 }
11266
11267 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
11268 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
11269
11270 static int
11271 x_error_handler (display, error)
11272 Display *display;
11273 XErrorEvent *error;
11274 {
11275 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
11276 x_error_catcher (display, error);
11277 else
11278 x_error_quitter (display, error);
11279 return 0;
11280 }
11281
11282 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
11283 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
11284 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
11285
11286 static int
11287 x_io_error_quitter (display)
11288 Display *display;
11289 {
11290 char buf[256];
11291
11292 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
11293 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
11294 return 0;
11295 }
11296 \f
11297 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
11298
11299 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
11300 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
11301 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
11302 The return value shows which font we chose. */
11303
11304 Lisp_Object
11305 x_new_font (f, fontname)
11306 struct frame *f;
11307 register char *fontname;
11308 {
11309 struct font_info *fontp
11310 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
11311
11312 if (!fontp)
11313 return Qnil;
11314
11315 f->output_data.x->font = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
11316 f->output_data.x->baseline_offset = fontp->baseline_offset;
11317 f->output_data.x->fontset = -1;
11318
11319 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
11320 if (f->scroll_bar_pixel_width > 0)
11321 {
11322 int wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
11323 f->scroll_bar_cols = (f->scroll_bar_pixel_width + wid-1) / wid;
11324 }
11325 else
11326 {
11327 int wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
11328 f->scroll_bar_cols = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
11329 }
11330
11331 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
11332 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
11333 {
11334 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
11335 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
11336 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
11337 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
11338 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
11339 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
11340
11341 frame_update_line_height (f);
11342 x_set_window_size (f, 0, f->width, f->height);
11343 }
11344 else
11345 /* If we are setting a new frame's font for the first time,
11346 there are no faces yet, so this font's height is the line height. */
11347 f->output_data.x->line_height = FONT_HEIGHT (f->output_data.x->font);
11348
11349 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
11350 }
11351
11352 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
11353 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
11354 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
11355 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
11356
11357 Lisp_Object
11358 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
11359 struct frame *f;
11360 char *fontsetname;
11361 {
11362 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
11363 Lisp_Object result;
11364
11365 if (fontset < 0)
11366 return Qnil;
11367
11368 if (f->output_data.x->fontset == fontset)
11369 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
11370 to do. */
11371 return fontset_name (fontset);
11372
11373 result = x_new_font (f, (XSTRING (fontset_ascii (fontset))->data));
11374
11375 if (!STRINGP (result))
11376 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
11377 return Qnil;
11378
11379 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
11380 f->output_data.x->fontset = fontset;
11381
11382 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11383 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
11384 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
11385 xic_set_xfontset (f, XSTRING (fontset_ascii (fontset))->data);
11386 #endif
11387
11388 return build_string (fontsetname);
11389 }
11390
11391 \f
11392 /***********************************************************************
11393 X Input Methods
11394 ***********************************************************************/
11395
11396 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11397
11398 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
11399
11400 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
11401 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
11402 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
11403
11404 static void
11405 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
11406 XIM xim;
11407 XPointer client_data;
11408 XPointer call_data;
11409 {
11410 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
11411 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
11412
11413 BLOCK_INPUT;
11414
11415 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
11416 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11417 {
11418 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
11419 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
11420 {
11421 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
11422 if (FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f))
11423 {
11424 XFreeFontSet (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f));
11425 FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f) = NULL;
11426 }
11427 }
11428 }
11429
11430 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
11431 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
11432 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
11433 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11434 }
11435
11436 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
11437
11438 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
11439 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
11440
11441 static void
11442 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
11443 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11444 char *resource_name;
11445 {
11446 #ifdef USE_XIM
11447 XIM xim;
11448
11449 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
11450 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
11451
11452 if (xim)
11453 {
11454 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
11455 XIMCallback destroy;
11456 #endif
11457
11458 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
11459 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
11460
11461 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
11462 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
11463 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
11464 /* This isn't prptotyped in OSF 5.0. */
11465 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
11466 #endif
11467 }
11468
11469 #else /* not USE_XIM */
11470 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
11471 #endif /* not USE_XIM */
11472 }
11473
11474
11475 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
11476
11477 struct xim_inst_t
11478 {
11479 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11480 char *resource_name;
11481 };
11482
11483 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
11484 server is available. DISPLAY is teh display of the XIM.
11485 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
11486 when the callback was registered. */
11487
11488 static void
11489 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
11490 Display *display;
11491 XPointer client_data;
11492 XPointer call_data;
11493 {
11494 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
11495 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
11496
11497 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
11498 if (dpyinfo->xim)
11499 return;
11500
11501 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
11502
11503 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
11504 as they have no XIC. */
11505 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
11506 {
11507 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11508
11509 BLOCK_INPUT;
11510 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11511 {
11512 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
11513
11514 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
11515 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
11516 {
11517 create_frame_xic (f);
11518 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
11519 xic_set_statusarea (f);
11520 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
11521 {
11522 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
11523 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
11524 }
11525 }
11526 }
11527
11528 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11529 }
11530 }
11531
11532 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
11533
11534
11535 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
11536 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
11537 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
11538 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
11539
11540 static void
11541 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
11542 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11543 char *resource_name;
11544 {
11545 #ifdef USE_XIM
11546 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
11547 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
11548 int len;
11549
11550 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
11551 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
11552 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
11553 len = strlen (resource_name);
11554 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
11555 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
11556 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
11557 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
11558 xim_instantiate_callback,
11559 /* Fixme: This is XPointer in
11560 XFree86 but (XPointer *) on
11561 Tru64, at least. */
11562 (XPointer) xim_inst);
11563 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
11564 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
11565 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
11566 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
11567
11568 #else /* not USE_XIM */
11569 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
11570 #endif /* not USE_XIM */
11571 }
11572
11573
11574 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
11575
11576 static void
11577 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
11578 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11579 {
11580 #ifdef USE_XIM
11581 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
11582 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
11583 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
11584 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
11585 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
11586 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
11587 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
11588 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
11589 #endif /* USE_XIM */
11590 }
11591
11592 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
11593
11594
11595 \f
11596 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
11597 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
11598
11599 void
11600 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
11601 struct frame *f;
11602 {
11603 Window child;
11604 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
11605 int flags = f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags;
11606 int this_window;
11607
11608 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
11609 is already for the top-left corner. */
11610 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
11611 return;
11612
11613 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11614 this_window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
11615 #else
11616 this_window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
11617 #endif
11618
11619 /* Find the position of the outside upper-left corner of
11620 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
11621 But do this only if we will need the results. */
11622 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
11623 {
11624 int count;
11625
11626 BLOCK_INPUT;
11627 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
11628 while (1)
11629 {
11630 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
11631 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
11632
11633 /* From-window, to-window. */
11634 this_window,
11635 f->output_data.x->parent_desc,
11636
11637 /* From-position, to-position. */
11638 0, 0, &win_x, &win_y,
11639
11640 /* Child of win. */
11641 &child);
11642 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
11643 {
11644 Window newroot, newparent = 0xdeadbeef;
11645 Window *newchildren;
11646 unsigned int nchildren;
11647
11648 if (! XQueryTree (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), this_window, &newroot,
11649 &newparent, &newchildren, &nchildren))
11650 break;
11651
11652 XFree ((char *) newchildren);
11653
11654 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = newparent;
11655 }
11656 else
11657 break;
11658 }
11659
11660 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
11661 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11662 }
11663
11664 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
11665 position that fits on the screen. */
11666 if (flags & XNegative)
11667 f->output_data.x->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
11668 - 2 * f->output_data.x->border_width - win_x
11669 - PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
11670 + f->output_data.x->left_pos);
11671
11672 if (flags & YNegative)
11673 {
11674 int menubar_height = 0;
11675
11676 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11677 if (f->output_data.x->menubar_widget)
11678 menubar_height
11679 = (f->output_data.x->menubar_widget->core.height
11680 + f->output_data.x->menubar_widget->core.border_width);
11681 #endif
11682
11683 f->output_data.x->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
11684 - 2 * f->output_data.x->border_width
11685 - win_y
11686 - PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)
11687 - menubar_height
11688 + f->output_data.x->top_pos);
11689 }
11690
11691 /* The left_pos and top_pos
11692 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
11693 so the flags should correspond. */
11694 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
11695 }
11696
11697 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
11698 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
11699 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
11700 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
11701 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
11702
11703 void
11704 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
11705 struct frame *f;
11706 register int xoff, yoff;
11707 int change_gravity;
11708 {
11709 int modified_top, modified_left;
11710
11711 if (change_gravity > 0)
11712 {
11713 f->output_data.x->top_pos = yoff;
11714 f->output_data.x->left_pos = xoff;
11715 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
11716 if (xoff < 0)
11717 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
11718 if (yoff < 0)
11719 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
11720 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
11721 }
11722 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
11723
11724 BLOCK_INPUT;
11725 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
11726
11727 modified_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
11728 modified_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
11729 #if 0 /* Running on psilocin (Debian), and displaying on the NCD X-terminal,
11730 this seems to be unnecessary and incorrect. rms, 4/17/97. */
11731 /* It is a mystery why we need to add the border_width here
11732 when the frame is already visible, but experiment says we do. */
11733 if (change_gravity != 0)
11734 {
11735 modified_left += f->output_data.x->border_width;
11736 modified_top += f->output_data.x->border_width;
11737 }
11738 #endif
11739
11740 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11741 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
11742 modified_left, modified_top);
11743 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11744 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11745 modified_left, modified_top);
11746 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11747 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11748 }
11749
11750 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
11751 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
11752 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
11753 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
11754
11755 void
11756 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
11757 struct frame *f;
11758 int change_gravity;
11759 int cols, rows;
11760 {
11761 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11762 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
11763 #endif
11764
11765 BLOCK_INPUT;
11766
11767 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11768 {
11769 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
11770 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
11771 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
11772 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
11773 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
11774 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
11775 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
11776 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
11777 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
11778 }
11779
11780 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11781
11782 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
11783 f->output_data.x->vertical_scroll_bar_extra
11784 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
11785 ? 0
11786 : FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) > 0
11787 ? FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
11788 : (FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font)));
11789 f->output_data.x->flags_areas_extra
11790 = FRAME_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
11791 pixelwidth = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
11792 pixelheight = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
11793
11794 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
11795 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
11796
11797 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
11798 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11799 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
11800
11801 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
11802 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
11803 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
11804 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
11805
11806 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
11807 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
11808 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
11809 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
11810 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
11811
11812 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
11813 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
11814 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
11815 PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
11816 PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
11817
11818 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
11819 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
11820 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
11821 we have to make sure to do it here. */
11822 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
11823
11824 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
11825
11826 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11827
11828 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
11829 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
11830
11831 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
11832 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
11833 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
11834 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
11835 cancel_mouse_face (f);
11836
11837 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11838 }
11839 \f
11840 /* Mouse warping. */
11841
11842 void
11843 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
11844 struct frame *f;
11845 int x, y;
11846 {
11847 int pix_x, pix_y;
11848
11849 pix_x = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_COL (f, x) + FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font) / 2;
11850 pix_y = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_ROW (f, y) + f->output_data.x->line_height / 2;
11851
11852 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
11853 if (pix_x > PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
11854
11855 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
11856 if (pix_y > PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
11857
11858 BLOCK_INPUT;
11859
11860 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11861 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
11862 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11863 }
11864
11865 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
11866
11867 void
11868 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
11869 struct frame *f;
11870 int pix_x, pix_y;
11871 {
11872 BLOCK_INPUT;
11873
11874 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11875 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
11876 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11877 }
11878 \f
11879 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
11880
11881 void
11882 x_focus_on_frame (f)
11883 struct frame *f;
11884 {
11885 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
11886 x_raise_frame (f);
11887 #endif
11888 #if 0
11889 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
11890 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
11891 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
11892 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11893 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
11894 #endif /* ! 0 */
11895 }
11896
11897 void
11898 x_unfocus_frame (f)
11899 struct frame *f;
11900 {
11901 #if 0
11902 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
11903 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
11904 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
11905 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
11906 #endif /* ! 0 */
11907 }
11908
11909 /* Raise frame F. */
11910
11911 void
11912 x_raise_frame (f)
11913 struct frame *f;
11914 {
11915 if (f->async_visible)
11916 {
11917 BLOCK_INPUT;
11918 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11919 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget));
11920 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11921 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
11922 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11923 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
11924 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11925 }
11926 }
11927
11928 /* Lower frame F. */
11929
11930 void
11931 x_lower_frame (f)
11932 struct frame *f;
11933 {
11934 if (f->async_visible)
11935 {
11936 BLOCK_INPUT;
11937 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11938 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget));
11939 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11940 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
11941 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11942 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
11943 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11944 }
11945 }
11946
11947 static void
11948 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
11949 FRAME_PTR f;
11950 int raise_flag;
11951 {
11952 if (raise_flag)
11953 x_raise_frame (f);
11954 else
11955 x_lower_frame (f);
11956 }
11957 \f
11958 /* Change of visibility. */
11959
11960 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
11961 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
11962 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
11963 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
11964 but it will become visible later when the window manager
11965 finishes with it. */
11966
11967 void
11968 x_make_frame_visible (f)
11969 struct frame *f;
11970 {
11971 Lisp_Object type;
11972 int original_top, original_left;
11973 int retry_count = 2;
11974
11975 retry:
11976
11977 BLOCK_INPUT;
11978
11979 type = x_icon_type (f);
11980 if (!NILP (type))
11981 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
11982
11983 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
11984 {
11985 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
11986 call x_set_offset a second time
11987 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
11988 before the window gets really visible. */
11989 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
11990 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
11991 x_set_offset (f, f->output_data.x->left_pos, f->output_data.x->top_pos, 0);
11992
11993 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
11994
11995 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
11996 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
11997 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11998 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
11999 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
12000 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12001 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
12002 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12003 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
12004 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
12005 to come back ok without this. */
12006 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
12007 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
12008 #endif
12009 }
12010
12011 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12012
12013 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
12014 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
12015 so that incoming events are handled. */
12016 {
12017 Lisp_Object frame;
12018 int count;
12019 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
12020 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
12021 will set it when they are handled. */
12022 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
12023
12024 original_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
12025 original_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
12026
12027 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
12028 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12029
12030 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
12031
12032 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
12033 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
12034 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
12035 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
12036
12037 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
12038 because the window manager may choose the position
12039 and we don't want to override it. */
12040
12041 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
12042 && f->output_data.x->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
12043 && previously_visible)
12044 {
12045 Drawable rootw;
12046 int x, y;
12047 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
12048
12049 BLOCK_INPUT;
12050
12051 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
12052 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
12053 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
12054 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
12055 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
12056 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
12057 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
12058 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
12059 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
12060
12061 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
12062 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
12063 original_left, original_top);
12064
12065 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12066 }
12067
12068 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12069
12070 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
12071 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
12072 MapNotify at all.. */
12073 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
12074 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
12075 {
12076 /* Force processing of queued events. */
12077 x_sync (f);
12078
12079 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
12080 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
12081 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
12082 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
12083 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
12084 probably a bug. */
12085 if (input_polling_used ())
12086 {
12087 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
12088 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
12089 handler reset it. */
12090 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
12091 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
12092 poll_suppress_count = 1;
12093 poll_for_input_1 ();
12094 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
12095 }
12096
12097 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
12098 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
12099 }
12100
12101 /* 2000-09-28: In
12102
12103 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
12104 (iconify-frame f)
12105 (raise-frame f))
12106
12107 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
12108 FreeBSD, Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
12109 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
12110 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
12111
12112 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
12113 goto retry;
12114 }
12115 }
12116
12117 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
12118
12119 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
12120
12121 void
12122 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
12123 struct frame *f;
12124 {
12125 Window window;
12126
12127 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12128 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
12129 window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
12130 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12131 window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
12132 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12133
12134 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
12135 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
12136 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
12137
12138 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
12139 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
12140 return;
12141 #endif
12142
12143 BLOCK_INPUT;
12144
12145 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
12146 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
12147 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
12148 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
12149 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
12150 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
12151
12152 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
12153
12154 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
12155 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
12156 {
12157 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
12158 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
12159 }
12160 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
12161
12162 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
12163 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
12164 {
12165 XEvent unmap;
12166
12167 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
12168 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
12169 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12170 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
12171 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
12172 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
12173 False,
12174 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
12175 &unmap))
12176 {
12177 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
12178 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
12179 }
12180 }
12181
12182 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
12183 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
12184 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
12185
12186 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
12187 just by the event that we get from the server.
12188 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
12189 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
12190 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
12191 f->visible = 0;
12192 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
12193 f->async_visible = 0;
12194 f->async_iconified = 0;
12195
12196 x_sync (f);
12197
12198 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12199 }
12200
12201 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
12202
12203 void
12204 x_iconify_frame (f)
12205 struct frame *f;
12206 {
12207 int result;
12208 Lisp_Object type;
12209
12210 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
12211 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
12212 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
12213
12214 if (f->async_iconified)
12215 return;
12216
12217 BLOCK_INPUT;
12218
12219 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
12220
12221 type = x_icon_type (f);
12222 if (!NILP (type))
12223 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
12224
12225 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12226
12227 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
12228 {
12229 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
12230 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
12231 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
12232 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
12233 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
12234 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
12235 so we have to record it here. */
12236 f->iconified = 1;
12237 f->visible = 1;
12238 f->async_iconified = 1;
12239 f->async_visible = 0;
12240 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12241 return;
12242 }
12243
12244 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
12245 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
12246 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
12247 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12248
12249 if (!result)
12250 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
12251
12252 f->async_iconified = 1;
12253 f->async_visible = 0;
12254
12255
12256 BLOCK_INPUT;
12257 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12258 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12259 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12260
12261 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
12262 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
12263 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
12264 x_set_offset (f, f->output_data.x->left_pos, f->output_data.x->top_pos, 0);
12265
12266 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
12267 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
12268
12269 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
12270 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
12271 {
12272 XEvent message;
12273
12274 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
12275 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
12276 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
12277 message.xclient.format = 32;
12278 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
12279
12280 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
12281 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
12282 False,
12283 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
12284 &message))
12285 {
12286 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
12287 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
12288 }
12289 }
12290
12291 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
12292 IconicState. */
12293 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
12294
12295 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
12296 {
12297 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
12298 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
12299 }
12300
12301 f->async_iconified = 1;
12302 f->async_visible = 0;
12303
12304 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12305 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12306 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12307 }
12308 \f
12309 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
12310
12311 void
12312 x_destroy_window (f)
12313 struct frame *f;
12314 {
12315 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12316
12317 BLOCK_INPUT;
12318
12319 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
12320 commands to the X server. */
12321 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
12322 {
12323 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc != 0)
12324 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
12325 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
12326 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
12327 free_frame_xic (f);
12328 #endif
12329 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->window_desc);
12330 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12331 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
12332 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
12333 free_frame_menubar (f);
12334 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12335
12336 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
12337 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
12338 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
12339 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
12340 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
12341 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
12342 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
12343 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
12344 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
12345 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
12346 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
12347 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
12348 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
12349 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
12350
12351 free_frame_faces (f);
12352 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12353 }
12354
12355 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
12356 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
12357
12358 xfree (f->output_data.x);
12359 f->output_data.x = 0;
12360 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
12361 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
12362 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
12363 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
12364 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
12365 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
12366
12367 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
12368
12369 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
12370 {
12371 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12372 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
12373 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12374 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
12375 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
12376 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
12377 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
12378 }
12379
12380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12381 }
12382 \f
12383 /* Setting window manager hints. */
12384
12385 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
12386 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
12387 that the window now has.
12388 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
12389 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0). */
12390
12391 void
12392 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
12393 struct frame *f;
12394 long flags;
12395 int user_position;
12396 {
12397 XSizeHints size_hints;
12398
12399 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12400 Arg al[2];
12401 int ac = 0;
12402 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
12403 Window window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
12404 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12405 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
12406 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12407
12408 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
12409 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
12410
12411 size_hints.x = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
12412 size_hints.y = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
12413
12414 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12415 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
12416 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
12417 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
12418 size_hints.height = widget_height;
12419 size_hints.width = widget_width;
12420 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12421 size_hints.height = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
12422 size_hints.width = PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
12423 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12424
12425 size_hints.width_inc = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
12426 size_hints.height_inc = f->output_data.x->line_height;
12427 size_hints.max_width
12428 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
12429 size_hints.max_height
12430 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
12431
12432 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
12433
12434 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
12435 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
12436 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12437 {
12438 int base_width, base_height;
12439 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
12440
12441 base_width = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
12442 base_height = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
12443
12444 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
12445
12446 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
12447 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
12448 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
12449 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
12450 zero-row, zero-column frame.
12451
12452 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
12453 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
12454 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
12455
12456 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
12457 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
12458 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
12459 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
12460 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
12461 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
12462 #else
12463 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
12464 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
12465 #endif
12466 }
12467
12468 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
12469 if (flags)
12470 {
12471 size_hints.flags |= flags;
12472 goto no_read;
12473 }
12474 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12475
12476 {
12477 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
12478 long supplied_return;
12479 int value;
12480
12481 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
12482 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
12483 &supplied_return);
12484 #else
12485 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
12486 #endif
12487
12488 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12489 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
12490 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
12491 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
12492 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
12493 #endif
12494
12495 if (flags)
12496 size_hints.flags |= flags;
12497 else
12498 {
12499 if (value == 0)
12500 hints.flags = 0;
12501 if (hints.flags & PSize)
12502 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
12503 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
12504 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
12505 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
12506 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
12507 if (hints.flags & USSize)
12508 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
12509 }
12510 }
12511
12512 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12513 no_read:
12514 #endif
12515
12516 #ifdef PWinGravity
12517 size_hints.win_gravity = f->output_data.x->win_gravity;
12518 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
12519
12520 if (user_position)
12521 {
12522 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
12523 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
12524 }
12525 #endif /* PWinGravity */
12526
12527 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
12528 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
12529 #else
12530 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
12531 #endif
12532 }
12533
12534 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
12535
12536 void
12537 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
12538 struct frame *f;
12539 int state;
12540 {
12541 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12542 Arg al[1];
12543
12544 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
12545 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
12546 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12547 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
12548
12549 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
12550 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
12551
12552 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
12553 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12554 }
12555
12556 void
12557 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
12558 struct frame *f;
12559 int pixmap_id;
12560 {
12561 Pixmap icon_pixmap;
12562
12563 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12564 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
12565 #endif
12566
12567 if (pixmap_id > 0)
12568 {
12569 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
12570 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
12571 }
12572 else
12573 {
12574 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
12575 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
12576 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
12577 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
12578 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
12579 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
12580 best to explicitly give up. */
12581 #if 0
12582 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
12583 #else
12584 return;
12585 #endif
12586 }
12587
12588 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
12589
12590 {
12591 Arg al[1];
12592 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
12593 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
12594 }
12595
12596 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12597
12598 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPixmapHint;
12599 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
12600
12601 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12602 }
12603
12604 void
12605 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
12606 struct frame *f;
12607 int icon_x, icon_y;
12608 {
12609 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12610 Window window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
12611 #else
12612 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
12613 #endif
12614
12615 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
12616 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
12617 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
12618
12619 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
12620 }
12621
12622 \f
12623 /***********************************************************************
12624 Fonts
12625 ***********************************************************************/
12626
12627 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
12628
12629 struct font_info *
12630 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
12631 FRAME_PTR f;
12632 int font_idx;
12633 {
12634 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
12635 }
12636
12637
12638 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame
12639 F. If SIZE is not 0, it is the size (maximum bound width) of fonts
12640 to be listed. Frame F NULL means we have not yet created any
12641 frame on X, and consult the first display in x_display_list.
12642 MAXNAMES sets a limit on how many fonts to match. */
12643
12644 Lisp_Object
12645 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
12646 FRAME_PTR f;
12647 Lisp_Object pattern;
12648 int size;
12649 int maxnames;
12650 {
12651 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
12652 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
12653 Display *dpy = f != NULL ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f) : x_display_list->display;
12654 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
12655 int count;
12656
12657 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
12658 if (NILP (patterns))
12659 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
12660
12661 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
12662 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
12663 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
12664
12665 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
12666 {
12667 int num_fonts;
12668 char **names = NULL;
12669
12670 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
12671 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
12672 The cache is an alist of the form:
12673 (((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...)
12674 */
12675 if (f && (tem = XCDR (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->name_list_element),
12676 key = Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
12677 !NILP (list = Fassoc (key, tem))))
12678 {
12679 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
12680 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
12681 goto label_cached;
12682 }
12683
12684 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
12685
12686 BLOCK_INPUT;
12687 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
12688
12689 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
12690 {
12691 XFontStruct *font;
12692 unsigned long value;
12693
12694 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, XSTRING (pattern)->data);
12695 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
12696 {
12697 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
12698 server. Let's just ignore it. */
12699 font = NULL;
12700 x_clear_errors (dpy);
12701 }
12702
12703 if (font
12704 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
12705 {
12706 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
12707 int len = strlen (name);
12708 char *tmp;
12709
12710 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
12711 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
12712 string. We must avoid such a name. */
12713 if (len == 0)
12714 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
12715 else
12716 {
12717 num_fonts = 1;
12718 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
12719 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
12720 simple var. */
12721 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
12722 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
12723 XFree (name);
12724 }
12725 }
12726 else
12727 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
12728
12729 if (font)
12730 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
12731 }
12732
12733 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
12734 {
12735 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
12736 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
12737 names = XListFonts (dpy, XSTRING (pattern)->data, max (maxnames, 10),
12738 &num_fonts);
12739 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
12740 {
12741 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
12742 server. Let's just ignore it. */
12743 names = NULL;
12744 x_clear_errors (dpy);
12745 }
12746 }
12747
12748 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
12749 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12750
12751 if (names)
12752 {
12753 int i;
12754
12755 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
12756 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
12757 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
12758 {
12759 int width = 0;
12760 char *p = names[i];
12761 int average_width = -1, dashes = 0;
12762
12763 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
12764 14 dashes, and the field value following 12th dash
12765 (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a auto-scaled font which
12766 is usually too ugly to be used for editing. Let's
12767 ignore it. */
12768 while (*p)
12769 if (*p++ == '-')
12770 {
12771 dashes++;
12772 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
12773 width = atoi (p);
12774 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
12775 average_width = atoi (p);
12776 }
12777 if (dashes < 14 || average_width != 0)
12778 {
12779 tem = build_string (names[i]);
12780 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
12781 {
12782 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
12783 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
12784 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
12785 >= 0))
12786 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
12787 width of this font. */
12788 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
12789 else
12790 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
12791 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
12792 }
12793 }
12794 }
12795 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
12796 XFreeFontNames (names);
12797 }
12798
12799 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
12800 if (f != NULL)
12801 XCDR (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->name_list_element)
12802 = Fcons (Fcons (key, list),
12803 XCDR (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->name_list_element));
12804
12805 label_cached:
12806 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
12807
12808 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
12809 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
12810 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
12811 {
12812 int found_size;
12813
12814 tem = XCAR (list);
12815
12816 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
12817 continue;
12818 if (!size)
12819 {
12820 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
12821 continue;
12822 }
12823
12824 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
12825 {
12826 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
12827 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
12828 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
12829
12830 BLOCK_INPUT;
12831 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
12832 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
12833 XSTRING (XCAR (tem))->data);
12834 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
12835 {
12836 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
12837 server. Let's just ignore it. */
12838 thisinfo = NULL;
12839 x_clear_errors (dpy);
12840 }
12841 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
12842 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12843
12844 if (thisinfo)
12845 {
12846 XCDR (tem)
12847 = (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
12848 ? make_number (0)
12849 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width));
12850 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
12851 }
12852 else
12853 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
12854 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
12855 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
12856 XCDR (tem) = make_number (0);
12857 }
12858
12859 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
12860 if (found_size == size)
12861 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
12862 else if (found_size > 0)
12863 {
12864 if (NILP (second_best))
12865 second_best = tem;
12866 else if (found_size < size)
12867 {
12868 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
12869 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
12870 second_best = tem;
12871 }
12872 else
12873 {
12874 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
12875 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
12876 second_best = tem;
12877 }
12878 }
12879 }
12880 if (!NILP (newlist))
12881 break;
12882 else if (!NILP (second_best))
12883 {
12884 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
12885 break;
12886 }
12887 }
12888
12889 return newlist;
12890 }
12891
12892
12893 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
12894
12895 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
12896 font table. */
12897
12898 static void
12899 x_check_font (f, font)
12900 struct frame *f;
12901 XFontStruct *font;
12902 {
12903 int i;
12904 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12905
12906 xassert (font != NULL);
12907
12908 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
12909 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
12910 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
12911 break;
12912
12913 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
12914 }
12915
12916 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
12917
12918 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
12919 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
12920 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
12921 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
12922 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
12923
12924 static INLINE void
12925 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
12926 XFontStruct *font;
12927 int *w, *h;
12928 {
12929 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
12930 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
12931
12932 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
12933 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
12934 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
12935 if (*w <= 0)
12936 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
12937 }
12938
12939
12940 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
12941 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
12942 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
12943 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
12944 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
12945
12946 static int
12947 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
12948 struct frame *f;
12949 {
12950 int i;
12951 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12952 XFontStruct *font;
12953 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
12954 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
12955
12956 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
12957 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
12958
12959 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
12960 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
12961 {
12962 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
12963 int w, h;
12964
12965 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
12966 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
12967 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
12968
12969 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
12970 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
12971 }
12972
12973 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
12974 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
12975
12976 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
12977 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
12978 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
12979 }
12980
12981
12982 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
12983 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
12984 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
12985 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
12986
12987 struct font_info *
12988 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
12989 struct frame *f;
12990 register char *fontname;
12991 int size;
12992 {
12993 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12994 Lisp_Object font_names;
12995 int count;
12996
12997 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
12998 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
12999 we already have by comparing names. */
13000 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
13001
13002 if (!NILP (font_names))
13003 {
13004 Lisp_Object tail;
13005 int i;
13006
13007 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
13008 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
13009 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
13010 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
13011 XSTRING (XCAR (tail))->data)
13012 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
13013 XSTRING (XCAR (tail))->data)))
13014 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
13015 }
13016
13017 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
13018 {
13019 char *full_name;
13020 XFontStruct *font;
13021 struct font_info *fontp;
13022 unsigned long value;
13023 int i;
13024
13025 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
13026 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
13027 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
13028 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
13029 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
13030 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
13031 fontname = (char *) XSTRING (XCAR (font_names))->data;
13032
13033 BLOCK_INPUT;
13034 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13035 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
13036 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
13037 {
13038 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
13039 server. Let's just ignore it. */
13040 font = NULL;
13041 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13042 }
13043 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
13044 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13045 if (!font)
13046 return NULL;
13047
13048 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
13049 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
13050 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
13051 break;
13052
13053 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
13054 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
13055 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
13056 {
13057 int sz;
13058 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
13059 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
13060 dpyinfo->font_table
13061 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
13062 }
13063
13064 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
13065 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
13066 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
13067
13068 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
13069 BLOCK_INPUT;
13070 fontp->font = font;
13071 fontp->font_idx = i;
13072 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
13073 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
13074
13075 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
13076 full_name = 0;
13077 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
13078 {
13079 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
13080 char *p = name;
13081 int dashes = 0;
13082
13083 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
13084 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
13085 so don't use it.
13086 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
13087 stored in them. */
13088 while (*p)
13089 {
13090 if (*p == '-')
13091 dashes++;
13092 p++;
13093 }
13094
13095 if (dashes >= 13)
13096 {
13097 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
13098 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
13099 }
13100
13101 XFree (name);
13102 }
13103
13104 if (full_name != 0)
13105 fontp->full_name = full_name;
13106 else
13107 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
13108
13109 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
13110 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
13111 {
13112 /* For some font, ascent and descent in max_bounds field is
13113 larger than the above value. */
13114 int max_height = font->max_bounds.ascent + font->max_bounds.descent;
13115 if (max_height > fontp->height)
13116 fontp->height = max_height;
13117 }
13118
13119 if (NILP (font_names))
13120 {
13121 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
13122 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
13123 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
13124 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
13125 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
13126
13127 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)
13128 = Fcons (Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
13129 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
13130 make_number (fontp->size)),
13131 Qnil)),
13132 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element));
13133 if (full_name)
13134 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)
13135 = Fcons (Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
13136 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
13137 make_number (fontp->size)),
13138 Qnil)),
13139 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element));
13140 }
13141
13142 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
13143 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
13144 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
13145 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
13146 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
13147 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
13148 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
13149 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
13150 fontp->encoding[1]
13151 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
13152 /* 1-byte font */
13153 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
13154 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
13155 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
13156 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
13157 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
13158 /* 2-byte font */
13159 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
13160 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
13161 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
13162 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
13163 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
13164 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
13165 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
13166 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
13167 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
13168 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
13169 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
13170 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
13171 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
13172
13173 fontp->baseline_offset
13174 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
13175 ? (long) value : 0);
13176 fontp->relative_compose
13177 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
13178 ? (long) value : 0);
13179 fontp->default_ascent
13180 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
13181 ? (long) value : 0);
13182
13183 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
13184 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
13185 before, or if the font loaded has a smalle>r height than any
13186 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
13187 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
13188 fonts_changed_p = x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
13189 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13190 return fontp;
13191 }
13192 }
13193
13194
13195 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
13196 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
13197
13198 struct font_info *
13199 x_query_font (f, fontname)
13200 struct frame *f;
13201 register char *fontname;
13202 {
13203 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
13204 int i;
13205
13206 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
13207 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
13208 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
13209 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
13210 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
13211 return NULL;
13212 }
13213
13214
13215 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
13216 `encoder' of the structure. */
13217
13218 void
13219 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
13220 struct font_info *fontp;
13221 {
13222 Lisp_Object list, elt;
13223
13224 elt = Qnil;
13225 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
13226 {
13227 elt = XCAR (list);
13228 if (CONSP (elt)
13229 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
13230 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
13231 >= 0)
13232 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
13233 >= 0)))
13234 break;
13235 }
13236
13237 if (! NILP (list))
13238 {
13239 struct ccl_program *ccl
13240 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
13241
13242 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
13243 xfree (ccl);
13244 else
13245 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
13246 }
13247 }
13248
13249
13250 \f
13251 /***********************************************************************
13252 Initialization
13253 ***********************************************************************/
13254
13255 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13256 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
13257 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
13258 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
13259
13260 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
13261 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
13262 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
13263
13264 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
13265 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
13266 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
13267 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
13268 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
13269 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
13270 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
13271 };
13272 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13273
13274 static int x_initialized;
13275
13276 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
13277 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
13278 the screen number from the server number. */
13279 static int
13280 same_x_server (name1, name2)
13281 char *name1, *name2;
13282 {
13283 int seen_colon = 0;
13284 unsigned char *system_name = XSTRING (Vsystem_name)->data;
13285 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
13286 int length_until_period = 0;
13287
13288 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
13289 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
13290 length_until_period++;
13291
13292 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
13293 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
13294 name1 += 4;
13295 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
13296 name2 += 4;
13297 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
13298 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
13299 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
13300 name1 += system_name_length;
13301 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
13302 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
13303 name2 += system_name_length;
13304 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
13305 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
13306 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
13307 name1 += length_until_period;
13308 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
13309 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
13310 name2 += length_until_period;
13311
13312 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
13313 {
13314 if (*name1 == ':')
13315 seen_colon++;
13316 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
13317 return 1;
13318 }
13319 return (seen_colon
13320 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
13321 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
13322 }
13323 #endif
13324
13325 struct x_display_info *
13326 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
13327 Lisp_Object display_name;
13328 char *xrm_option;
13329 char *resource_name;
13330 {
13331 int connection;
13332 Display *dpy;
13333 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
13334 XrmDatabase xrdb;
13335
13336 BLOCK_INPUT;
13337
13338 if (!x_initialized)
13339 {
13340 x_initialize ();
13341 x_initialized = 1;
13342 }
13343
13344 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13345 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
13346 errors with X11R5:
13347 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
13348 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
13349 So let's not use it until R6. */
13350 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
13351 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
13352 #endif
13353
13354 {
13355 int argc = 0;
13356 char *argv[3];
13357
13358 argv[0] = "";
13359 argc = 1;
13360 if (xrm_option)
13361 {
13362 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
13363 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
13364 }
13365 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, XSTRING (display_name)->data,
13366 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
13367 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
13368 &argc, argv);
13369
13370 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
13371 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
13372 fixup_locale ();
13373 #endif
13374 }
13375
13376 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13377 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
13378 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
13379 #endif
13380 dpy = XOpenDisplay (XSTRING (display_name)->data);
13381 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13382
13383 /* Detect failure. */
13384 if (dpy == 0)
13385 {
13386 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13387 return 0;
13388 }
13389
13390 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
13391
13392 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
13393 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
13394
13395 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
13396 {
13397 struct x_display_info *share;
13398 Lisp_Object tail;
13399
13400 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
13401 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
13402 if (same_x_server (XSTRING (XCAR (XCAR (tail)))->data,
13403 XSTRING (display_name)->data))
13404 break;
13405 if (share)
13406 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
13407 else
13408 {
13409 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
13410 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
13411 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
13412 {
13413 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
13414 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13415 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
13416 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
13417 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
13418 BLOCK_INPUT;
13419 }
13420
13421 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
13422 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
13423 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
13424 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
13425 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
13426 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
13427 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
13428 }
13429 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
13430 }
13431 #endif
13432
13433 /* Put this display on the chain. */
13434 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
13435 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
13436
13437 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
13438 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
13439 x_display_name_list);
13440 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
13441
13442 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
13443
13444 #if 0
13445 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
13446 #endif /* ! 0 */
13447
13448 dpyinfo->x_id_name
13449 = (char *) xmalloc (STRING_BYTES (XSTRING (Vinvocation_name))
13450 + STRING_BYTES (XSTRING (Vsystem_name))
13451 + 2);
13452 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
13453 XSTRING (Vinvocation_name)->data, XSTRING (Vsystem_name)->data);
13454
13455 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
13456 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
13457
13458 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
13459 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
13460 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
13461
13462 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
13463 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
13464 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
13465 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
13466 #else
13467 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
13468 #endif
13469 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
13470 all versions. */
13471 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
13472
13473 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
13474 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
13475 select_visual (dpyinfo);
13476 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
13477 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
13478 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
13479 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
13480 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
13481 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
13482 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
13483 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
13484 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
13485 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
13486 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
13487 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
13488 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
13489 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
13490 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
13491 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
13492 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
13493 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
13494 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
13495 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
13496 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
13497 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
13498 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
13499 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
13500 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
13501 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
13502
13503 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
13504 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
13505 {
13506 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
13507 {
13508 Lisp_Object value;
13509 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
13510 build_string ("privateColormap"),
13511 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
13512 Qnil, Qnil);
13513 if (STRINGP (value)
13514 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
13515 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
13516 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
13517 }
13518 }
13519 else
13520 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
13521 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
13522
13523 {
13524 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
13525 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
13526 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
13527 dpyinfo->resy = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
13528 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
13529 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
13530 dpyinfo->resx = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
13531 }
13532
13533 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
13534 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
13535 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
13536 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
13537 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
13538 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
13539 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
13540 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
13541 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
13542 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
13543 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
13544 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
13545 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
13546 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
13547 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
13548 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
13549 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
13550 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
13551 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
13552 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
13553 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
13554 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
13555 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
13556 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
13557 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
13558 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
13559 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
13560 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
13561 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
13562 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
13563 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
13564 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
13565 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
13566 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
13567 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
13568 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
13569 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
13570 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
13571 /* For properties of font. */
13572 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
13573 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
13574 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
13575 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
13576 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
13577 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
13578 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
13579 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
13580
13581 /* Ghostscript support. */
13582 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
13583 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
13584
13585 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
13586 False);
13587
13588 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
13589
13590 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
13591 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
13592
13593 {
13594 char null_bits[1];
13595
13596 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
13597
13598 dpyinfo->null_pixel
13599 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
13600 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
13601 1);
13602 }
13603
13604 {
13605 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
13606 extern unsigned char *gray_bitmap_bits;
13607 dpyinfo->gray
13608 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
13609 gray_bitmap_bits,
13610 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
13611 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
13612 }
13613
13614 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
13615 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
13616 #endif
13617
13618 #ifdef subprocesses
13619 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
13620 if (connection != 0)
13621 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
13622 #endif
13623
13624 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
13625 #ifdef F_SETOWN
13626 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
13627 /* stdin is a socket here */
13628 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
13629 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
13630 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
13631 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
13632 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
13633 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
13634
13635 #ifdef SIGIO
13636 if (interrupt_input)
13637 init_sigio (connection);
13638 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
13639
13640 #ifdef USE_LUCID
13641 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
13642 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
13643 so that Xt does not crash. */
13644 {
13645 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
13646 XrmValue d, fr, to;
13647 Font font;
13648 int count;
13649
13650 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
13651 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
13652 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
13653 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
13654 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
13655 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
13656 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
13657 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
13658 abort ();
13659 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
13660 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
13661 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
13662 }
13663 #endif
13664 #endif
13665
13666 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
13667 for debugging X code. */
13668 {
13669 Lisp_Object value;
13670 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
13671 build_string ("synchronous"),
13672 build_string ("Synchronous"),
13673 Qnil, Qnil);
13674 if (STRINGP (value)
13675 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
13676 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
13677 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
13678 }
13679
13680 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13681
13682 return dpyinfo;
13683 }
13684 \f
13685 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
13686 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
13687
13688 void
13689 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
13690 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
13691 {
13692 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
13693
13694 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
13695 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
13696 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
13697 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
13698 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
13699 else
13700 {
13701 Lisp_Object tail;
13702
13703 tail = x_display_name_list;
13704 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
13705 {
13706 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
13707 {
13708 XCDR (tail) = XCDR (XCDR (tail));
13709 break;
13710 }
13711 tail = XCDR (tail);
13712 }
13713 }
13714
13715 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
13716 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
13717
13718 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
13719 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
13720 else
13721 {
13722 struct x_display_info *tail;
13723
13724 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
13725 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
13726 tail->next = tail->next->next;
13727 }
13728
13729 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
13730 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
13731 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
13732 #endif
13733 #endif
13734 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
13735 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
13736 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
13737 #endif
13738 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
13739 if (dpyinfo->xim)
13740 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
13741 #endif
13742
13743 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
13744 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
13745 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
13746 xfree (dpyinfo);
13747 }
13748
13749 \f
13750 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
13751
13752 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
13753 {
13754 x_produce_glyphs,
13755 x_write_glyphs,
13756 x_insert_glyphs,
13757 x_clear_end_of_line,
13758 x_scroll_run,
13759 x_after_update_window_line,
13760 x_update_window_begin,
13761 x_update_window_end,
13762 XTcursor_to,
13763 x_flush,
13764 x_clear_mouse_face,
13765 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
13766 x_fix_overlapping_area
13767 };
13768
13769 void
13770 x_initialize ()
13771 {
13772 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
13773
13774 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
13775 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
13776 change_line_highlight_hook = x_change_line_highlight;
13777 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
13778 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
13779 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
13780 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
13781 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
13782 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
13783 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
13784 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
13785 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
13786 reassert_line_highlight_hook = XTreassert_line_highlight;
13787 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
13788 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
13789 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
13790 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
13791 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
13792 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
13793 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
13794 estimate_mode_line_height_hook = x_estimate_mode_line_height;
13795
13796 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
13797 char_ins_del_ok = 0; /* just as fast to write the line */
13798 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
13799 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
13800 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
13801 off the bottom */
13802 baud_rate = 19200;
13803
13804 x_noop_count = 0;
13805 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
13806 any_help_event_p = 0;
13807
13808 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
13809 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
13810
13811 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13812 XtToolkitInitialize ();
13813 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
13814 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
13815
13816 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
13817 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
13818 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
13819 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
13820 widgets don't behave normally. */
13821 {
13822 EMACS_TIME interval;
13823 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
13824 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
13825 }
13826 #endif
13827
13828 #if USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
13829 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
13830 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
13831 #endif
13832
13833 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
13834 original error handler. */
13835 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
13836 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
13837
13838 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
13839 #ifdef SIGWINCH
13840 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
13841 #endif /* ! defined (SIGWINCH) */
13842
13843 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
13844 }
13845
13846
13847 void
13848 syms_of_xterm ()
13849 {
13850 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
13851 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
13852
13853 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
13854 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
13855
13856 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
13857 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
13858
13859 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
13860 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
13861
13862 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
13863 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
13864
13865 help_echo = Qnil;
13866 staticpro (&help_echo);
13867 help_echo_object = Qnil;
13868 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
13869 help_echo_window = Qnil;
13870 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
13871 previous_help_echo = Qnil;
13872 staticpro (&previous_help_echo);
13873 help_echo_pos = -1;
13874
13875 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", &x_stretch_cursor_p,
13876 "*Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.\n\
13877 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as\n\
13878 wide as that tab on the display.");
13879 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
13880
13881 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars-p", &x_toolkit_scroll_bars_p,
13882 "If not nil, Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars.");
13883 #if USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
13884 x_toolkit_scroll_bars_p = 1;
13885 #else
13886 x_toolkit_scroll_bars_p = 0;
13887 #endif
13888
13889 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
13890 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
13891 }
13892
13893 #endif /* not HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
13894